drivers/xlnx-pcie-xvc: Group adapter commands
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @section Interface Drivers
2371
2372 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2373 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2374 available at run time.
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2377 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2378 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2379 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2380
2381 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2382 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2383 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2384 @end deffn
2385
2386 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2387 Displays status of RTCK option.
2388 Optionally sets that option first.
2389 @end deffn
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2393 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2394 This has one driver-specific command:
2395
2396 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2397 Logs some status
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2402 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2403 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2404 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2405 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2406 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2410 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2411 or v2 (USB bulk).
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2414 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2415 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2416 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2417 @example
2418 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2419 @end example
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2423 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2424 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2428 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2429
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2432 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2433 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2434 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2435 @end itemize
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2439 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2440 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2441 interface string or for user class interface.
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2445 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2446 @end deffn
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2450 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2454 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2458 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2459 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2460
2461 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2462 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2463
2464 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2465 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2466
2467 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2468 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2469 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2470 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2471 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2472 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2473
2474 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2475 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2476 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2477 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2478 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2479
2480 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2481 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2482 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2483 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2484
2485 @itemize @minus
2486 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2487 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2488 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2489 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2490 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2491 switching data and direction as necessary
2492 @end itemize
2493
2494 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2495 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2498 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2499 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2500 @example
2501 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2502 @end example
2503 @end deffn
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2506 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2507 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2508 during device selection.
2509 @end deffn
2510
2511 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi serial} serial-number
2512 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2513 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2514 is connected to the host.
2515 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2516 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2517 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2521 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2522 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2526 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2527 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2528 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2529 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2530 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2531 and initially asserted reset signals.
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2535 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2536 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2537 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2538 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2539 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2540 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2541 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2542 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2543 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2544 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2545
2546 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2547 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2548 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2549 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2550 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2551 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2552
2553 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2554 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2555 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2556 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2557 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2558 are always driven by the FTDI.
2559
2560 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2561 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2562 @var{name}.
2563 @end deffn
2564
2565 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2566 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2567 @itemize @minus
2568 @item @option{0}, drive low
2569 @item @option{1}, drive high
2570 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2571 @end itemize
2572 @end deffn
2573
2574 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2575 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2579 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2580
2581 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2582 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2583 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2584 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2585 @itemize @minus
2586 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2587 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2588 @end itemize
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2592 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2593
2594 @end deffn
2595
2596 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2597 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2598 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2599 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2600
2601 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2602 @itemize @minus
2603 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2604 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2605 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2606 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2607 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2608 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2609 @end itemize
2610
2611 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2612 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2613 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2614 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2615 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2616 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2617 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2618 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2619
2620 FT232R
2621 @itemize @minus
2622 @item bit 7 - RI
2623 @item bit 6 - DCD
2624 @item bit 5 - DSR
2625 @item bit 4 - DTR
2626 @item bit 3 - CTS
2627 @item bit 2 - RTS
2628 @item bit 1 - RXD
2629 @item bit 0 - TXD
2630 @end itemize
2631
2632 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2633 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2636 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2637 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2641 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2642 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2643 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2644 @end deffn
2645
2646 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2647 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2648 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2649 @end deffn
2650
2651 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2652 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2656 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2660 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2664 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2668 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2672 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2676 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2677 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2678 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2679 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2680 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2681 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2682 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2683 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2684 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2685 @end deffn
2686
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2690 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2691 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2692 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2693
2694 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2695 processors which are being simulated.
2696
2697 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2698 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2699 sockets instead of TCP.
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2703 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2704 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2708 something like:
2709
2710 @example
2711 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2712 remote_bitbang port 3335
2713 remote_bitbang host foobar
2714 @end example
2715
2716 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2717 named mysocket:
2718
2719 @example
2720 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2721 remote_bitbang port 0
2722 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2723 @end example
2724 @end deffn
2725
2726 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2727 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2728 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2729 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2730
2731 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2732 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2733 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2734 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2735 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2736 @end deffn
2737
2738 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2739 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2740 default values are used.
2741 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2742 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2743 @example
2744 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2745 @end example
2746 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2747 @example
2748 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2749 @end example
2750 @end deffn
2751
2752 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2753 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2754 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2755 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2756 target board.
2757
2758 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2759 @example
2760 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2761 reset_config srst_only
2762 @end example
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2766 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2767 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2768 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2769 @end deffn
2770
2771 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2772 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2773 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2774 @end deffn
2775
2776 @end deffn
2777
2778 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2779 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2780 This has one driver-specific command:
2781
2782 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2783 Display either the address of the I/O port
2784 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2785 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2786 This is a write-once setting.
2787 @end deffn
2788 @end deffn
2789
2790 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2791 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2792 transports.
2793
2794 @quotation Compatibility Note
2795 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2796 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2797 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2798 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2799 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2800 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2801 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2802 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2803 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2804 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2805 @end quotation
2806
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2808 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2809 states.
2810 @end deffn
2811 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2812 Display free device internal memory.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2815 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2816 command version.
2817 @end deffn
2818 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2819 Display the device configuration.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2822 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2823 power state.
2824 @end deffn
2825 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2826 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2827 @end deffn
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2829 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2830 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2831 IP configuration.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2834 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2835 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2836 @end deffn
2837 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2838 Reset the current configuration.
2839 @end deffn
2840 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2841 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2844 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2845 pairs.
2846
2847 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2848 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2849 @example
2850 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2851 @end example
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2854 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2855 pairs.
2856
2857 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2858 @example
2859 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2860 77a90000
2861 @end example
2862 @end deffn
2863 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2864 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2865 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2866 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2867 the serial number instead, if possible.
2868
2869 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2870 @end deffn
2871 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2872 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2873 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2874
2875 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2876 @end deffn
2877 @end deffn
2878
2879 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2880 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2881 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2882 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2883 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2884 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2885 configuration script.
2886
2887 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2888 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2889 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2890 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2891 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2892
2893 Known limitations:
2894 @itemize @bullet
2895 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2896 and 2.7 MHz.
2897 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2898 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2899 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2900 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2901 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2902 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2903 communications with the target.
2904 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2905 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2906 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2907 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2908 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2909 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2910 @end itemize
2911
2912 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2913 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2914 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2915 @end deffn
2916
2917 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2918 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2919 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2923 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2924 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2925 target as a side-effect.
2926 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2927 @end deffn
2928
2929 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2930 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2931 version, and target voltage.
2932 @end deffn
2933 @end deffn
2934
2935 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2936 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2937 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2938 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2939 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2940
2941 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2942 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2943 This is a write-once setting.
2944 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2945
2946 @itemize @minus
2947 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2948 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2949 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2950 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2951 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2952 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2953 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2954 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2955 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2956 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2957 some versions of
2958 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2959 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2960 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2961 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2962 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2963 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2964 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2965 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2966 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2967 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2968 @end itemize
2969 @end deffn
2970
2971 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2972 Display either the address of the I/O port
2973 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2974 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2975 This is a write-once setting.
2976
2977 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2978 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2979 you may encounter a problem.
2980 @end deffn
2981
2982 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2983 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2984 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2985 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2986 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2987 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2988
2989 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2990 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2991 @quotation Tip
2992 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2993 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2994 @example
2995 > parport toggling_time 1000
2996 > adapter speed 500
2997 @end example
2998 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2999 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3000 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3001 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3002 large set of samples.
3003 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3004 @example
3005 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3006 @end example
3007 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3008 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3009
3010 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3011 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3012 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3013 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3014 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3015 be conservative.
3016 @end quotation
3017 @end deffn
3018
3019 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3020 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3021 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3022 @end deffn
3023
3024 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3025 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3026
3027 @example
3028 adapter driver parport
3029 parport port 0x278
3030 parport cable wiggler
3031 @end example
3032 @end deffn
3033
3034 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3035 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3036 @deffn {Config Command} {presto serial} serial_string
3037 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3038 @end deffn
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3042 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3043 @end deffn
3044
3045 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3046 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3047 @end deffn
3048
3049 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3050 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3051
3052 @quotation Note
3053 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3054 which are not currently documented here.
3055 @end quotation
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @anchor{hla_interface}
3059 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3060 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3061 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3062 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3063
3064 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3065 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3066 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3067 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3068 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3069 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3070
3071 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3072 Currently Not Supported.
3073 @end deffn
3074
3075 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3076 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3077 @end deffn
3078
3079 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3080 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3081 @end deffn
3082
3083 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3084 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3088 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3089 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3090
3091 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3092 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3093 ST-LINK server software module}.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3097 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3098 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3099 @end deffn
3100 @end deffn
3101
3102 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3103 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3104 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3105 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3106 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3107
3108 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3109 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3110 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3111 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3112
3113 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3114 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3115
3116 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3117 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3118 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3119
3120 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3121 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3122 ST-LINK server software module}.
3123
3124 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3125 @end deffn
3126
3127 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3128 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3129 @end deffn
3130
3131 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3132 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3133 @end deffn
3134 @end deffn
3135
3136 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3137 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3138 @end deffn
3139
3140 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3141 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3145 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3146 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3147 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3148 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3149
3150 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3151 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3152 XDS110 found will be used.
3153 @end deffn
3154
3155 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3156 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3157 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3158 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3159 @end deffn
3160
3161 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3162 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3163 version).
3164 @end deffn
3165 @end deffn
3166
3167 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3168 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3169 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3170 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3171 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3172
3173 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3174
3175 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3176 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3177
3178 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3179 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3180
3181 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3182
3183 @end deffn
3184 @end deffn
3185
3186 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3187 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3188 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3189
3190 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3191 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3192 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3193 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3194 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3195 configuration on exit.
3196
3197 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3198 pinout.
3199
3200 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3201 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3202 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3203 individually.
3204 @end deffn
3205
3206 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_tck_num} @var{tck}
3207 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3208 specified using the configuration command bcm2835gpio_jtag_nums.
3209 @end deffn
3210
3211 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_tms_num} @var{tms}
3212 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3213 specified using the configuration command bcm2835gpio_jtag_nums.
3214 @end deffn
3215
3216 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3217 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3218 specified using the configuration command bcm2835gpio_jtag_nums.
3219 @end deffn
3220
3221 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3222 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3223 specified using the configuration command bcm2835gpio_jtag_nums.
3224 @end deffn
3225
3226 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3227 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3228 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3229 @end deffn
3230
3231 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3232 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3233 specified using the configuration command bcm2835gpio_swd_nums.
3234 @end deffn
3235
3236 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3237 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3238 specified using the configuration command bcm2835gpio_swd_nums.
3239 @end deffn
3240
3241 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3242 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3243 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3244 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3245 @end deffn
3246
3247 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_srst_num} @var{srst}
3248 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3249 @end deffn
3250
3251 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_trst_num} @var{trst}
3252 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3253 @end deffn
3254
3255 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3256 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3257 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3258 @end deffn
3259
3260 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio_peripheral_base} @var{base}
3261 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3262 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3263 list can be found in the
3264 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3265 @end deffn
3266
3267 @end deffn
3268
3269 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3270 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3271 of the one which is most popular.
3272
3273 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3274
3275 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3276 pinout.
3277
3278 @end deffn
3279
3280
3281 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3282 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3283 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3284
3285 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3286 @end deffn
3287
3288
3289 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3290 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3291 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3292
3293 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3294 @end deffn
3295
3296
3297 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3298 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3299 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3300
3301 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3302 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3303 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3304
3305 @itemize @minus
3306 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3307 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3308 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3309 @end itemize
3310 @end deffn
3311
3312 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3313 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3314 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3315 @end deffn
3316 @end deffn
3317
3318
3319 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3320 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3321 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3322 DPI server interface.
3323
3324 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3325 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3326 @end deffn
3327
3328 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3329 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3330 @end deffn
3331 @end deffn
3332
3333
3334 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3335
3336 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3337 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3338
3339 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3340 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3341
3342 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate_port} serial_port
3343 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3344 @example
3345 buspirate_port /dev/ttyUSB0
3346 @end example
3347 @end deffn
3348
3349 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate_speed} (normal|fast)
3350 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3351 @example
3352 buspirate_mode normal
3353 @end example
3354 @end deffn
3355
3356 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate_mode} (normal|open-drain)
3357 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3358 @itemize @minus
3359 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3360 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3361 @end itemize
3362 For example:
3363 @example
3364 buspirate_mode normal
3365 @end example
3366 @end deffn
3367
3368 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate_pullup} (0|1)
3369 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3370 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3371 For example:
3372 @example
3373 buspirate_pullup 0
3374 @end example
3375 @end deffn
3376
3377 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate_vreg} (0|1)
3378 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3379 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3380 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3381 @example
3382 buspirate_vreg 0
3383 @end example
3384 @end deffn
3385
3386 @deffn {Command} {buspirate_led} (0|1)
3387 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3388 @end deffn
3389 @example
3390 buspirate_led 1
3391 @end example
3392
3393 @end deffn
3394
3395
3396 @section Transport Configuration
3397 @cindex Transport
3398 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3399 and the debug adapter you are using,
3400 several transports may be available to
3401 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3402 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3403 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3404 version of OpenOCD.
3405 @end deffn
3406
3407 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3408 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3409
3410 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3411 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3412 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3413 adapter's driver).
3414
3415 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3416 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3417 supported by the debug adapter.
3418
3419 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3420 transport, if any.
3421 @end deffn
3422
3423 @subsection JTAG Transport
3424 @cindex JTAG
3425 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3426 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3427 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3428 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3429 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3430 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3431
3432 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3433 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3434 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3435 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3436 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3437
3438 @subsection SWD Transport
3439 @cindex SWD
3440 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3441 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3442 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3443 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3444 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3445 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3446 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3447
3448 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3449 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3450 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3451 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3452 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3453
3454 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3455 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3456 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3457 expected to change.
3458 @end deffn
3459 @deffn {Command} {swd wcr trn prescale}
3460 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3461 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3462 No parameters: displays current settings.
3463 @end deffn
3464
3465 @subsection SPI Transport
3466 @cindex SPI
3467 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3468 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3469 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3470 solution for flash programming.
3471
3472 @anchor{swimtransport}
3473 @subsection SWIM Transport
3474 @cindex SWIM
3475 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3476 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3477 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3478 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3479
3480 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3481
3482 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3483
3484 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3485 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3486 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3487 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3488 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3489
3490 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3491 @section JTAG Speed
3492 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3493 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3494 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3495 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3496 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3497 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3498 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3499 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3500 power management software that may be active.
3501
3502 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3503 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3504 target event handler.
3505 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3506 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3507 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3508 sets up those clocks).
3509 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3510 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3511 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3512 in the target config file.
3513 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3514 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3515 config file instead.
3516 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3517 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3518 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3519
3520 @example
3521 jtag_rclk 3000
3522 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3523 @end example
3524
3525 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3526 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3527 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3528 may not be the fastest solution.
3529
3530 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3531 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3532 which support adaptive clocking.
3533
3534 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3535 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3536 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3537 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3538 than the speed specified.
3539
3540 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3541 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3542 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3543 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3544
3545 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3546 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3547 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3548 JTAG clocking after setup.
3549 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3550 If the interface device can not
3551 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3552 @end deffn
3553
3554 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3555 @cindex adaptive clocking
3556 @cindex RTCK
3557 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3558 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3559 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3560 @example
3561 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3562 jtag_rclk 3000
3563 @end example
3564 @end defun
3565
3566 @node Reset Configuration
3567 @chapter Reset Configuration
3568 @cindex Reset Configuration
3569
3570 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3571 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3572 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3573 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3574 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3575 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3576 Please see the various board files for examples.
3577
3578 @quotation Note
3579 To maintainers and integrators:
3580 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3581 Normally the board configuration file
3582 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3583 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3584
3585 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3586 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3587 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3588 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3589 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3590 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3591 @end quotation
3592
3593 @section Types of Reset
3594
3595 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3596 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3597 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3598
3599 @itemize @bullet
3600 @item
3601 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3602 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3603 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3604 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3605 @item
3606 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3607 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3608 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3609 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3610 @item
3611 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3612 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3613 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3614 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3615 @item
3616 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3617 several other types of reset.
3618 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3619 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3620 There may be individual module resets.
3621 @end itemize
3622
3623 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3624 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3625 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3626 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3627 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3628 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3629 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3630 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3631 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3632
3633 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3634 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3635
3636 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3637 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3638 common issues are:
3639
3640 @itemize @bullet
3641
3642 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3643 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3644 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3645 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3646 when either of those signals is not connected.
3647 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3648 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3649 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3650 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3651
3652 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3653 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3654 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3655 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3656
3657 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3658 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3659 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3660 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3661 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3662 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3663 hardware debouncing.
3664 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3665 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3666
3667 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3668 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3669 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3670 to use push/pull output drivers.
3671 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3672 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3673 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3674 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3675
3676 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3677 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3678 issues (not limited to errata).
3679 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3680 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3681 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3682 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3683 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3684 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3685 @end itemize
3686
3687 There can also be other issues.
3688 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3689 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3690 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3691 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3692 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3693 Agreement (NDA).
3694
3695 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3696 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3697 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3698
3699 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3700 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3701
3702 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3703
3704 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3705 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3706 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3707 allowing it to be deasserted.
3708 @end deffn
3709
3710 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3711 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3712 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3713 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3714 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3715 @end deffn
3716
3717 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3718 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3719 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3720 allowing it to be deasserted.
3721 @end deffn
3722
3723 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3724 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3725 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3726 @end deffn
3727
3728 @anchor{reset_config}
3729 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3730 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3731 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3732 configuration scripts.
3733
3734 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3735 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3736 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3737 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3738 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3739 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3740 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3741 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3742
3743 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3744 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3745 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3746 -- may be specified at a time.
3747 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3748 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3749 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3750 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3751 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3752
3753 @itemize
3754 @item
3755 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3756 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3757 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3758 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3759 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3760
3761 @quotation Tip
3762 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3763 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3764 @end quotation
3765
3766 @item
3767 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3768 signal implementations.
3769 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3770 indicating everything behaves normally.
3771 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3772 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3773 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3774 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3775 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3776 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3777 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3778
3779 @item
3780 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3781 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3782 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3783 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3784 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3785 while SRST is asserted.
3786 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3787 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3788
3789 @item
3790 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3791 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3792 is required to use this option.
3793 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3794 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3795 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3796 be asserted before any target connection.
3797 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3798 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3799 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3800 @end itemize
3801
3802 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3803 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3804 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3805 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3806 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3807
3808 @itemize
3809 @item
3810 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3811 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3812 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3813 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3814
3815 @item
3816 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3817 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3818 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3819 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3820 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3821 @end itemize
3822 @end deffn
3823
3824 @section Custom Reset Handling
3825 @cindex events
3826
3827 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3828 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3829 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3830 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3831 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3832 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3833
3834 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3835 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3836 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3837 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3838 want to reset everything at once.
3839
3840 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3841 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3842 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3843 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3844 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3845 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3846 needs special attention.
3847
3848 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3849 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3850 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3851 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3852 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3853 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3854 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3855 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3856 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3857
3858 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3859 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3860 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3861 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3862 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3863
3864 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3865 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3866 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3867 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3868 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3869 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3870 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3871 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3872 or potentially some other value.
3873
3874 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3875 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3876 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3877 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3878 (or their associated targets)
3879 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3880
3881 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3882 they return.
3883 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3884 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3885 @end deffn
3886
3887 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3888 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3889 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3890 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3891 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3892 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3893 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3894 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3895 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3896 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3897 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3898 @end deffn
3899
3900 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3901 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3902 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3903 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3904 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3905 @end deffn
3906
3907
3908 @node TAP Declaration
3909 @chapter TAP Declaration
3910 @cindex TAP declaration
3911 @cindex TAP configuration
3912
3913 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3914 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3915
3916 @itemize @bullet
3917 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3918 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3919 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3920 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3921 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3922 start running that code.
3923 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3924 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3925 and missing connections.
3926 @end itemize
3927
3928 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3929 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3930 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3931 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3932 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3933
3934 @section Scan Chains
3935 @cindex scan chain
3936
3937 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3938 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3939 They also need to be added to
3940 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3941 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3942 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3943 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3944 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3945 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3946 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3947 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3948
3949 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3950 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3951 command, presented in the next chapter.
3952 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3953 debugging targets.)
3954 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3955
3956 @verbatim
3957 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3958 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3959 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3960 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3961 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3962 @end verbatim
3963
3964 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3965 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3966 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3967 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3968 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3969 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3970 until they are told to do so.
3971
3972 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3973 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3974 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3975 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3976
3977 @example
3978 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3979 @end example
3980
3981 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3982 by a given chip.
3983 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3984 and so forth.
3985 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3986 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3987 both inside a single chip and between them.
3988 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3989
3990 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3991 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3992 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3993 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3994 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3995 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3996 includes commands something like this:
3997
3998 @example
3999 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4000 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4001 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4002 @end example
4003
4004 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4005 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4006 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4007
4008 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4009 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4010 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4011 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4012 @example
4013 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4014 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4015 @}
4016 @end example
4017 @end deffn
4018
4019 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4020 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4021 and their status.
4022 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4023 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4024 but systems with a JTAG router can
4025 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4026 @end deffn
4027
4028 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4029 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4030
4031 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4032 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4033
4034 @section TAP Names
4035 @cindex dotted name
4036
4037 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4038 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4039 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4040 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4041 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4042 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4043 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4044 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4045
4046 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4047 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4048 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4049
4050 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4051
4052 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4053 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4054 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4055
4056 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4057 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4058 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4059 overridable.
4060
4061 @cindex TAP naming convention
4062 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4063 and should follow this convention:
4064
4065 @itemize @bullet
4066 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4067 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4068 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4069 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4070 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4071 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4072 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4073 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4074 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4075 with a single TAP;
4076 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4077 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4078 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4079 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4080 @end itemize
4081
4082 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4083
4084 @itemize @bullet
4085 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4086 @*The length in bits of the
4087 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4088 @end itemize
4089
4090 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4091
4092 @itemize @bullet
4093 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4094 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4095 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4096 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4097 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4098 (the TAP is linked in).
4099 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4100 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4101 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4102 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4103 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4104 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4105 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4106 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4107 values that were found but not included in the list.
4108
4109 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4110 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4111 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4112 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4113 hardware to find these values.
4114 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4115 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4116 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4117 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4118 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4119 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4120 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4121 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4122 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4123 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4124 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4125 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4126 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4127 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4128 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4129 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4130 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4131 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4132 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4133 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4134 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4135 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4136 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4137 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4138 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4139 @end itemize
4140 @end deffn
4141
4142 @section Other TAP commands
4143
4144 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4145 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4146 @end deffn
4147
4148 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4149 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4150 At this writing this TAP attribute
4151 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4152 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4153 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4154 See the next section for information about the available events.
4155
4156 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4157 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4158 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4159 @end deffn
4160
4161 @section TAP Events
4162 @cindex events
4163 @cindex TAP events
4164
4165 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4166 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4167 The other applies to debugger targets,
4168 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4169
4170 The TAP events currently defined are:
4171
4172 @itemize @bullet
4173 @item @b{post-reset}
4174 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4175 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4176 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4177 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4178 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4179
4180 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4181 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4182 of any particular target.
4183 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4184 @item @b{setup}
4185 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4186 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4187 @item @b{tap-disable}
4188 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4189 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4190 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4191 @item @b{tap-enable}
4192 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4193 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4194 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4195 @end itemize
4196
4197 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4198 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4199 contents to be accurate), you might:
4200
4201 @example
4202 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4203 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4204 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4205 @}
4206 @end example
4207
4208
4209 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4210 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4211 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4212 @cindex jrc
4213
4214 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4215 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4216 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4217 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4218 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4219
4220 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4221 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4222 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4223 be visible.
4224 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4225 ignores, such as:
4226
4227 @itemize
4228 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4229 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4230 TAPs receive new instructions.
4231 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4232 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4233 @end itemize
4234
4235 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4236 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4237 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4238 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4239
4240 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4241 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4242
4243 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4244 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4245 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4246 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4247 should define TAP event handlers using
4248 code that looks something like this:
4249
4250 @example
4251 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4252 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4253 @}
4254 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4255 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4256 @}
4257 @end example
4258
4259 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4260
4261 @example
4262 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4263 @end example
4264
4265 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4266 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4267 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4268 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4269
4270 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4271 If necessary, disables the tap
4272 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4273 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4274 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4275 and "0" if it is disabled.
4276 @end deffn
4277
4278 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4279 If necessary, enables the tap
4280 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4281 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4282 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4283 and "0" if it is disabled.
4284 @end deffn
4285
4286 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4287 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4288 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4289 and "0" if it is disabled.
4290
4291 @quotation Note
4292 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4293 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4294 @end quotation
4295 @end deffn
4296
4297 @anchor{autoprobing}
4298 @section Autoprobing
4299 @cindex autoprobe
4300 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4301
4302 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4303 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4304 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4305 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4306
4307 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4308 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4309 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4310 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4311 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4312 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4313 right when they come out of reset).
4314
4315 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4316
4317 @example
4318 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4319 reset_config trst_and_srst
4320 jtag_rclk 8
4321 @end example
4322
4323 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4324 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4325
4326 @enumerate
4327 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4328 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4329 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4330 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4331 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4332 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4333 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4334 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4335 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4336 that is discovered.
4337 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4338 register, it will report it.
4339 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4340 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4341 @end enumerate
4342
4343 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4344 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4345 that's a bit more complex:
4346
4347 @example
4348 clock speed 8 kHz
4349 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4350 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4351 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4352 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4353 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4354 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4355 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4356 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4357 @end example
4358
4359 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4360 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4361 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4362 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4363 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4364 and so forth.
4365
4366 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4367 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4368 @cindex DAP declaration
4369
4370 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4371 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4372 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4373 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4374 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4375
4376 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4377
4378 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4379 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4380 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4381 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4382 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4383
4384 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4385
4386 @itemize @bullet
4387 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4388 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4389 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4390 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4391 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4392 @end itemize
4393 @end deffn
4394
4395 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4396 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4397 for TCL scripting.
4398 @end deffn
4399
4400 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4401 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4402 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4403 @end deffn
4404
4405 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4406 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4407 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4408 initialization, too.
4409 @end deffn
4410
4411 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4412
4413 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4414 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4415 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4416 @end deffn
4417
4418 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4419 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4420 @end deffn
4421
4422 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4423 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4424 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4425 or set a new value @var{value}.
4426 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4427 @end deffn
4428
4429 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4430 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4431 @end deffn
4432
4433 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4434 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4435 value @var{value}.
4436
4437 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4438 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4439 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4440
4441 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4442 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4443 @end deffn
4444
4445 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4446 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4447 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4448 @end deffn
4449
4450 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4451 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4452 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4453 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4454 @end deffn
4455
4456 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4457 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4458
4459 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4460 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4461 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4462 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4463 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4464 for details.
4465
4466 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4467 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4468 the pattern:
4469 @example
4470 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4471 @end example
4472
4473 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4474 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4475 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4476 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4477 @example
4478 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4479 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4480 @end example
4481
4482 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4483 @example
4484 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4485 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4486 @end example
4487
4488 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4489 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4490
4491 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4492 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4493 example with a proper dap name:
4494 @example
4495 xxx.dap apcsw default
4496 @end example
4497 @end deffn
4498
4499 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4500 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4501 Disabled by default
4502 @end deffn
4503
4504
4505 @node CPU Configuration
4506 @chapter CPU Configuration
4507 @cindex GDB target
4508
4509 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4510 You can also access these targets without GDB
4511 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4512 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4513 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4514 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4515
4516 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4517 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4518
4519 @section Target List
4520 @cindex target, current
4521 @cindex target, list
4522
4523 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4524 where each member has a name.
4525 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4526 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4527 (plural!) command.
4528 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4529 look like with more than one:
4530 @verbatim
4531 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4532 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4533 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4534 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4535 @end verbatim
4536
4537 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4538 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4539 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4540 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4541 space seen by that current target.
4542 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4543 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4544 are examples; and there are many more.
4545
4546 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4547
4548 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4549 Returns the name of the current target.
4550 @end deffn
4551
4552 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4553 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4554 @example
4555 foreach t [target names] @{
4556 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4557 @}
4558 @end example
4559 @end deffn
4560
4561 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4562 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4563
4564 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4565 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4566 command names are singular.}
4567
4568 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4569 targets in a user friendly form.
4570
4571 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4572 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4573 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4574 @end deffn
4575
4576 @section Target CPU Types
4577 @cindex target type
4578 @cindex CPU type
4579
4580 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4581 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4582 when calling @command{target create}.
4583 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4584 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4585 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4586 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4587 what core-specific commands may be available
4588 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4589 and more.
4590
4591 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4592 since there's a command to list them.
4593
4594 @anchor{targettypes}
4595 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4596 Lists all supported target types.
4597 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4598
4599 @itemize @bullet
4600 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4601 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4602 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4603 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4604 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4605 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4606 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4607 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4608 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4609 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4610 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4611 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4612 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4613 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4614 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4615 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4616 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4617 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4618 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4619 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4620 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4621 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4622 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4623 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4624 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4625 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4626 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4627 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4628 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4629 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4630 support for new CPUs.
4631 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4632 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4633 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4634 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4635 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4636 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4637 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4638 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4639 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4640 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4641 @itemize @minus
4642 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4643 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4644 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4645 @end itemize
4646 And two debug interfaces cores:
4647 @itemize @minus
4648 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4649 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4650 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4651 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4652 @end itemize
4653 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4654 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4655 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4656 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4657 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4658 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4659 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4660 @end itemize
4661 @end deffn
4662
4663 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4664 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4665 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4666 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4667 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4668 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4669 reflect design generations;
4670 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4671 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4672
4673 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4674 @section Target Configuration
4675
4676 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4677 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4678 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4679 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4680 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4681
4682 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4683 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4684 optional parts.
4685 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4686 command, created as part of target creation.
4687
4688 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4689 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4690 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4691 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4692 to be much more board-specific.
4693 The key steps you use might look something like this
4694
4695 @example
4696 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4697 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4698 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4699 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4700 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4701 @end example
4702
4703 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4704 on-chip SRAM.
4705 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4706 writes to target memory;
4707 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4708 GDB memory checksumming;
4709 and more.
4710
4711 @quotation Warning
4712 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4713 inaccessible when application code
4714 (such as an operating system)
4715 enables or disables the MMU.
4716 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4717 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4718 easy access to other addresses needed.
4719 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4720 @end quotation
4721
4722 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4723 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4724 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4725 controllers.
4726 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4727 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4728 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4729
4730 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4731 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4732 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4733 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4734 purposes including additional configuration.
4735
4736 @itemize @bullet
4737 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4738 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4739 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4740 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4741
4742 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4743 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4744 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4745 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4746 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4747 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4748 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4749
4750 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4751 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4752 @end itemize
4753 @end deffn
4754
4755 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4756 The options accepted by this command may also be
4757 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4758 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4759 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4760
4761 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4762 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4763 and changing its endianness.
4764
4765 @itemize @bullet
4766
4767 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4768 used to access this target.
4769
4770 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4771 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4772 create and manage DAP instances.
4773
4774 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4775 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4776
4777 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4778 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4779 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4780 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4781 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4782 same event name assigns only one handler.
4783
4784 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4785 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4786
4787 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4788 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4789 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4790 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4791 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4792 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4793 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4794
4795 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4796 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4797 or virtual address is being used.
4798
4799 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4800 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4801
4802 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4803 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4804 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4805 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4806 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4807
4808 @anchor{rtostype}
4809 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4810 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4811 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4812 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4813 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4814 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4815
4816 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4817 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4818 access the target for debugging.
4819
4820 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4821 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4822 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4823 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4824
4825 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4826 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4827 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4828 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4829 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4830
4831 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4832 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4833 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4834 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4835 command @command{gdb_port}.
4836 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4837
4838 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4839 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4840 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4841 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4842 @end itemize
4843 @end deffn
4844
4845 @section Other $target_name Commands
4846 @cindex object command
4847
4848 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4849 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4850
4851 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4852 Once a button is created a button
4853 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4854 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4855 configure it like this:
4856
4857 @example
4858 # Create
4859 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4860 # Modify
4861 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4862 # Query
4863 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4864 # Report
4865 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4866 @end example
4867
4868 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4869 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4870
4871 @example
4872 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4873 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4874 @end example
4875
4876 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4877
4878 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4879 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4880 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4881 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4882 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4883 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4884 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4885 They are not otherwise documented here.
4886 @end deffn
4887
4888 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4889 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4890 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4891 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4892 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4893 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4894 the target side uses raw memory.
4895
4896 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4897 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4898 The script orientation comes from working with data
4899 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4900 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4901 and neither store nor return those values.
4902
4903 @itemize
4904 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4905 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4906 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4907 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4908 @end itemize
4909 @end deffn
4910
4911 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4912 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4913 @command{$target_name configure}
4914 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4915 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4916 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4917 There are a few special cases:
4918
4919 @itemize @bullet
4920 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4921 event named @var{event_name}.
4922 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4923 two parameters.
4924 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4925 This is a special case because this is set using
4926 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4927 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4928 @end itemize
4929
4930 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4931 all the targets you might use something like this:
4932
4933 @example
4934 foreach name [target names] @{
4935 set y [$name cget -endian]
4936 set z [$name cget -type]
4937 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4938 $x $name $y $z]
4939 @}
4940 @end example
4941 @end deffn
4942
4943 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4944 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4945 Displays the current target state:
4946 @code{debug-running},
4947 @code{halted},
4948 @code{reset},
4949 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4950 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4951 @end deffn
4952
4953 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4954 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4955 currently associated with this target.
4956 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4957 @end deffn
4958
4959 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4960 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4961 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4962 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4963 @end deffn
4964
4965 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4966 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4967 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4968 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4969 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4970 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4971 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4972 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4973 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4974 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4975 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4976 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4977 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4978 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4979 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4980 @end deffn
4981
4982 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4983 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4984 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4985 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4986 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4987 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4988 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4989 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4990 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4991 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4992 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4993 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4994 @end deffn
4995
4996 @anchor{targetevents}
4997 @section Target Events
4998 @cindex target events
4999 @cindex events
5000 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5001 For example:
5002 @itemize @bullet
5003 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5004 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5005 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5006 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5007 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5008 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5009 to set up system clocks or
5010 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5011 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5012 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5013 @end itemize
5014
5015 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5016 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5017 @command{target create ... -event}.
5018
5019 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5020 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5021 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5022
5023 @example
5024 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5025 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5026 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5027 @}
5028 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5029 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5030 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5031 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5032 @}
5033 @end example
5034
5035 The following target events are defined:
5036
5037 @itemize @bullet
5038 @item @b{debug-halted}
5039 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5040 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5041 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5042 @item @b{early-halted}
5043 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5044 @item @b{examine-start}
5045 @* Before target examine is called.
5046 @item @b{examine-end}
5047 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5048 @item @b{examine-fail}
5049 @* After target examine fails.
5050 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5051 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5052 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5053 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5054 connect GDB to running target.
5055 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5056 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5057 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5058 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5059 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5060 is in RAM or read only memory.
5061 Default is @code{halt}
5062 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5063 @* When GDB disconnects
5064 @item @b{gdb-end}
5065 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5066 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5067 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5068 @code{reset init})
5069 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5070 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5071 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5072 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5073 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5074 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5075 @item @b{gdb-start}
5076 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5077 @item @b{halted}
5078 @* The target has halted
5079 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5080 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5081 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5082 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5083 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5084 @item @b{reset-assert}
5085 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5086 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5087 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5088 it instead of asserting SRST.
5089 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5090 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5091 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5092 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5093 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5094 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5095 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5096 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5097 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5098 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5099 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5100 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5101 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5102 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5103 released on the scan chain.
5104 @item @b{reset-end}
5105 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5106 @item @b{reset-init}
5107 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5108 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5109
5110 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5111 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5112 multiplexing, and so on.
5113 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5114 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5115 @item @b{reset-start}
5116 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5117 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5118
5119 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5120 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5121 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5122 @item @b{resume-start}
5123 @* Before any target is resumed
5124 @item @b{resume-end}
5125 @* After all targets have resumed
5126 @item @b{resumed}
5127 @* Target has resumed
5128 @item @b{step-start}
5129 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5130 @item @b{step-end}
5131 @* After single-step has completed
5132 @item @b{trace-config}
5133 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5134 @end itemize
5135
5136 @quotation Note
5137 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5138 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5139 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5140 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5141 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5142 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5143 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5144 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5145 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5146 check if the core has changed status.
5147 @end quotation
5148
5149 @node Flash Commands
5150 @chapter Flash Commands
5151
5152 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5153 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5154 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5155 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5156 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5157 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5158 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5159 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5160 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5161
5162 Flash Steps:
5163 @enumerate
5164 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5165 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5166 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5167 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5168 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5169 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5170 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5171 @item GDB Flashing
5172 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5173 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5174 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5175 @end enumerate
5176
5177 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5178 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5179 so that it can't boot.
5180 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5181 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5182
5183 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5184 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5185 @cindex flash configuration
5186
5187 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5188 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5189 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5190 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5191 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5192 see the driver-specific documentation.
5193
5194 @itemize @bullet
5195 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5196 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5197 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5198 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5199 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5200 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5201 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5202 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5203 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5204 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5205 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5206 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5207 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5208 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5209 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5210 commands to the flash controller.
5211 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5212 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5213 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5214 for more information.
5215 @end itemize
5216 @quotation Note
5217 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5218 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5219 @end quotation
5220 @end deffn
5221
5222 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5223 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5224 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5225 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5226 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5227 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5228 @end deffn
5229
5230 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5231 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5232 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5233 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5234 @end deffn
5235
5236 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5237 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5238 depends on the flash type.
5239 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5240 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5241 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5242 but most don't bother.
5243 @end deffn
5244
5245 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5246
5247 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5248 begins.
5249
5250 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5251 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5252 until the programming session is finished.
5253
5254 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5255 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5256
5257 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5258
5259 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5260 @cindex flash erasing
5261 @cindex flash reading
5262 @cindex flash writing
5263 @cindex flash programming
5264 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5265
5266 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5267 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5268 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5269 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5270 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5271
5272 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5273 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5274 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5275 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5276 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5277
5278 @quotation Note
5279 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5280 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5281 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5282 back to a flash bank.
5283 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5284 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5285 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5286 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5287 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5288 @end quotation
5289
5290 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5291 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5292 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5293 disabled first.
5294 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5295 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5296 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5297
5298 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5299 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5300 up to and including @var{last}.
5301 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5302 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5303 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5304 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5305 @end deffn
5306
5307 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5308 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5309 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5310 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5311 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5312 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5313 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5314 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5315 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5316 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5317 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5318 before erase starts.
5319 @end deffn
5320
5321 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5322 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5323 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5324 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5325 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5326 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5327 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5328 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5329 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5330 before issuing this command.
5331 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5332 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5333 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5334 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5335 @end deffn
5336 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5337
5338 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5339 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5340 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5341 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5342 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5343 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5344 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5345 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5346 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5347 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5348 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5349 @end deffn
5350
5351 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5352 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5353 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5354 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5355 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5356 @end deffn
5357
5358 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5359 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5360 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5361 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5362 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5363 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5364 @end deffn
5365
5366 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5367 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5368 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5369 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5370 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5371 @end deffn
5372
5373 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5374 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5375 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5376 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5377 to the base address for each section in the image.
5378 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5379 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5380 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5381 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5382 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5383 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5384 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5385 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5386 each image section.
5387
5388 @quotation Warning
5389 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5390 data you want to preserve.
5391 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5392 sections might be erased with no notice.
5393 @itemize
5394 @item
5395 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5396 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5397 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5398 @item
5399 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5400 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5401 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5402 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5403 @end itemize
5404 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5405 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5406 @end quotation
5407
5408 @end deffn
5409
5410 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5411 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5412 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5413 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5414 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5415 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5416 ordinary memory reads.
5417 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5418 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5419 check for successful programming.
5420 @end deffn
5421
5422 @section Other Flash commands
5423 @cindex flash protection
5424
5425 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5426 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5427 and display that status.
5428 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5429 @end deffn
5430
5431 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5432 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5433 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5434
5435 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5436 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5437 and possibly stale information.
5438 @end deffn
5439
5440 @anchor{flashprotect}
5441 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5442 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5443 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5444 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5445 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5446 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5447 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5448 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5449 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5450 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5451 @end deffn
5452
5453 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5454 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5455 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5456 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5457 @end deffn
5458
5459 @anchor{program}
5460 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5461 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5462 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5463 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5464 @end deffn
5465
5466 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5467 @section Flash Driver List
5468 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5469 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5470 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5471
5472 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5473 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5474 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5475
5476 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5477
5478 @itemize
5479 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5480 @end itemize
5481
5482 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5483 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5484 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5485 @example
5486 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5487 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5488 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5489 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5490 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5491 @end example
5492 @end deffn
5493
5494 @subsection External Flash
5495
5496 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5497 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5498 @cindex CFI
5499 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5500 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5501 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5502 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5503 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5504 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5505 configure a bus and its timings), or
5506 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5507 on the flash chip.
5508 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5509 speed up operation.
5510
5511 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5512
5513 @itemize
5514 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5515 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5516 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5517 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5518 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5519 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5520 @end itemize
5521
5522 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5523 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5524
5525 @example
5526 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5527 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5528 @end example
5529
5530 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5531 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5532 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5533
5534 @example
5535 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5536 @end example
5537
5538 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5539 @end deffn
5540
5541 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5542 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5543 @cindex SPI
5544 @cindex jtagspi
5545 @cindex bscan_spi
5546 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5547 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5548 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5549 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5550 accessed through JTAG.
5551
5552 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5553 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5554 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5555 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5556 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5557 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5558
5559 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5560 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5561 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5562 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5563 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5564 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5565 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5566 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5567
5568 @itemize
5569 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5570 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5571 @var{USER1} instruction.
5572 @end itemize
5573
5574 @example
5575 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5576 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5577 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5578 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5579 @end example
5580 @end deffn
5581
5582 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5583 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5584 @cindex xcf
5585 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5586 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5587 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5588 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5589 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5590
5591 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5592 command accepts additional parameters:
5593 @itemize
5594 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5595 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5596 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5597 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5598 in master mode.
5599 @end itemize
5600 @example
5601 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5602 @end example
5603 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5604 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5605 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5606 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5607 dedicated sector.
5608 @end deffn
5609
5610 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5611 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5612 button.
5613 @example
5614 xcf configure 0
5615 @end example
5616 @end deffn
5617
5618 Additional driver notes:
5619 @itemize
5620 @item Only single revision supported.
5621 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5622 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5623 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5624 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5625 @end itemize
5626 @end deffn
5627
5628 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5629 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5630 @cindex SPIFI
5631 @cindex lpcspifi
5632 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5633 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5634 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5635
5636 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5637 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5638 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5639 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5640 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5641
5642 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5643 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5644 are configured by the driver.
5645
5646 @example
5647 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5648 @end example
5649
5650 @end deffn
5651
5652 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5653 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5654 @cindex SMI
5655 @cindex stmsmi
5656 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5657 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5658 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5659 SPI flash devices.
5660 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5661 flash devices can be connected.
5662
5663 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5664 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5665 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5666 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5667 the flash content.
5668
5669 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5670 to identify the memory bank.
5671 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5672 flash size, are detected automatically.
5673
5674 @example
5675 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5676 @end example
5677
5678 @end deffn
5679
5680 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5681 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5682 @cindex QuadSPI
5683 @cindex OctoSPI
5684 @cindex stmqspi
5685 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5686 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5687 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5688 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5689 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5690 mode is not.
5691
5692 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5693 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5694 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5695 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5696
5697 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5698 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5699 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5700
5701 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5702 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5703 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5704 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5705 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5706 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5707
5708 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5709 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5710 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5711 should be avoided.
5712
5713 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5714 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5715 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5716 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5717 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5718 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5719
5720 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5721 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5722 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5723 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5724 persist across openocd invocations.
5725
5726 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5727 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5728 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5729 required (see 'set' command).
5730
5731 @example
5732 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5733 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5734 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5735 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5736 @end example
5737
5738 There are three specific commands
5739 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5740 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5741 chip specific write protection engaged.
5742 @end deffn
5743
5744 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5745 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5746 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5747 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5748 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5749 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5750
5751 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5752 which don't support an id command.
5753
5754 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5755 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5756 @end deffn
5757
5758 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5759 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5760 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5761 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5762 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5763
5764 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5765 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5766 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5767 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5768
5769 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5770
5771 To check basic communication settings, issue
5772 @example
5773 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5774 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5775 @end example
5776 for single flash mode or
5777 @example
5778 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5779 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5780 @end example
5781 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5782
5783 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5784 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5785 need a dummy address, e.g.
5786 @example
5787 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5788 @end example
5789 should return the status register contents.
5790
5791 @end deffn
5792
5793 @end deffn
5794
5795 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5796 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5797 Microcontroller platform.
5798
5799 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5800 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5801
5802 @example
5803 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5804 @end example
5805
5806 @end deffn
5807
5808 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5809 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5810 @cindex ath79
5811 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5812 chip selects.
5813 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5814 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5815 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5816 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5817 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5818 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5819
5820 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5821 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5822 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5823 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5824 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5825 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5826 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5827 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5828 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5829 with the default CS0.
5830 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5831 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5832 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5833
5834 @example
5835 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5836
5837 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5838 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5839 # distinguish the banks.
5840 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5841 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5842 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5843 @end example
5844
5845 @end deffn
5846
5847 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5848 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5849 @cindex fespi
5850
5851 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5852
5853 @example
5854 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5855 @end example
5856 @end deffn
5857
5858 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5859
5860 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5861 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5862 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5863 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5864 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5865 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5866
5867 @example
5868 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5869 @end example
5870 @end deffn
5871
5872 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5873 @cindex ambiqmicro
5874 @cindex apollo
5875 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5876 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5877 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5878 with the target using SWD.
5879
5880 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5881 the device class of the MCU.
5882 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5883 to set up the flash banks.
5884 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5885 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5886
5887 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5888 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5889 and the second bank starts after the first.
5890
5891 @example
5892 # Flash bank 0
5893 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5894 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5895 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5896 $_TARGETNAME
5897 @end example
5898
5899 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5900 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5901 are available to the user.
5902
5903 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5904
5905 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5906 Erase entire bank.
5907 @end deffn
5908 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5909 Erase device pages.
5910 @end deffn
5911 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5912 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5913 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5914 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5915 the flash.
5916 @end deffn
5917 @end deffn
5918
5919 @anchor{at91samd}
5920 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5921 @cindex at91samd
5922 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5923 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5924
5925 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5926
5927 The devices have one flash bank:
5928
5929 @example
5930 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5931 @end example
5932
5933 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5934 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5935 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5936 processor to be halted.
5937 @end deffn
5938
5939 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5940 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5941 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5942 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5943 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5944 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5945
5946 @example
5947 at91samd set-security enable
5948 @end example
5949 @end deffn
5950
5951 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5952 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5953 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5954 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5955 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5956 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5957 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5958 in order to disable this feature.
5959
5960 @example
5961 at91samd eeprom
5962 at91samd eeprom 1024
5963 @end example
5964 @end deffn
5965
5966 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
5967 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5968 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5969 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5970 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5971 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5972
5973 @example
5974 at91samd bootloader
5975 at91samd bootloader 16384
5976 @end example
5977 @end deffn
5978
5979 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5980 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5981 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5982 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5983 @end deffn
5984
5985 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5986 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5987 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5988 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5989 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5990 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5991 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5992 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5993
5994 @example
5995 # Read user row
5996 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5997 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5998 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5999 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6000 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6001 # byte unchanged
6002 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6003 @end example
6004 @end deffn
6005
6006 @end deffn
6007
6008 @anchor{at91sam3}
6009 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6010 @cindex at91sam3
6011 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6012 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6013 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6014 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6015 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6016 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6017 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6018 chips are confirmed.}
6019
6020 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6021 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6022 the following fixed locations:
6023
6024 @example
6025 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6026 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6027 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6028 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6029 @end example
6030
6031 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6032 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6033 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6034
6035 @itemize
6036 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6037 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6038 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6039 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6040 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6041 @end itemize
6042
6043 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6044
6045 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6046 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6047 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6048 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6049 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6050 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6051 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6052
6053 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6054 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6055 @end deffn
6056
6057 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6058 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6059 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6060 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6061 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6062 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6063 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6064 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6065 @end deffn
6066
6067 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6068 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6069 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6070 @end deffn
6071 @end deffn
6072
6073 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6074 @cindex at91sam4
6075 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6076 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6077 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6078 @end deffn
6079
6080 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6081 @cindex at91sam4l
6082 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6083 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6084 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6085
6086 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6087 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6088 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6089 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6090 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6091 @end deffn
6092 @end deffn
6093
6094 @anchor{atsame5}
6095 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6096 @cindex atsame5
6097 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6098 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6099 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6100
6101 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6102 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6103 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6104
6105 @example
6106 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6107 @end example
6108
6109 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6110 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6111 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6112 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6113 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6114 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6115
6116 @example
6117 atsame5 bootloader
6118 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6119 @end example
6120 @end deffn
6121
6122 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6123 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6124 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6125 processor to be halted.
6126 @end deffn
6127
6128 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6129 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6130 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6131 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6132 @end deffn
6133
6134 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6135 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6136 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6137 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6138 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6139 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6140 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6141 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6142
6143 @example
6144 # Read
6145 >atsame5 userpage
6146 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6147 # Write
6148 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6149 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6150 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6151 # bytes)
6152 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6153 @end example
6154 @end deffn
6155
6156 @end deffn
6157
6158 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6159 @cindex atsamv
6160 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6161 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6162 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6163 @end deffn
6164
6165 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6166 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6167 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6168 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6169 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6170
6171 @example
6172 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6173 @end example
6174
6175 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6176 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6177
6178 @itemize
6179 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6180 @item @var{banks}
6181 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6182 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6183 @item @var{pages_size}
6184 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6185 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6186 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6187 @end itemize
6188
6189 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6190 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6191 will be autoconfigured.
6192 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6193
6194 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6195 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6196 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6197 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6198 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6199
6200 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6201 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6202 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6203 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6204 are not truly general purpose).
6205 @quotation Note
6206 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6207 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6208 @end quotation
6209 @end deffn
6210 @end deffn
6211
6212 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6213 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6214 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6215 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6216 @end deffn
6217
6218 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6219 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6220 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6221 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6222
6223 @example
6224 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6225 @end example
6226
6227 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6228 each single sector one by one.
6229
6230 @example
6231 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6232 @end example
6233
6234 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6235 @end deffn
6236
6237 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6238 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6239 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6240 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6241 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6242 starts at address 0.
6243
6244 @example
6245 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6246 @end example
6247 @end deffn
6248
6249 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6250 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6251 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6252 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6253 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6254 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6255 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6256 and programming the serial flash.
6257
6258 @example
6259 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6260 @end example
6261 @end deffn
6262
6263 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6264 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6265 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6266 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6267 autoconfigures itself.
6268 @example
6269 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6270 @end example
6271 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6272 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6273 this via the following command:
6274 @example
6275 efm32 debuglock num
6276 @end example
6277 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6278 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6279 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6280 supported.}
6281 @end deffn
6282
6283 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6284 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6285 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6286 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6287 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6288 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6289
6290 @example
6291 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6292 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6293 @end example
6294
6295 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6296 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6297 @end deffn
6298
6299 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6300 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6301 is an uncommon operation.}
6302 @end deffn
6303 @end deffn
6304
6305 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6306 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6307 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6308 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6309 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6310 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6311 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6312
6313 @example
6314 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6315 @end example
6316 @end deffn
6317
6318 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6319 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6320 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6321 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6322 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6323 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6324 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6325 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6326 characters) ignored.
6327
6328 @example
6329 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6330 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6331 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6332 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6333 @end example
6334 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6335 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6336 @end deffn
6337
6338 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6339 @cindex kinetis
6340 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6341 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6342 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6343 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6344 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6345 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6346
6347 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6348 @itemize
6349 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6350 @end itemize
6351
6352 @example
6353 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6354 @end example
6355
6356 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6357 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6358 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6359 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6360 @end deffn
6361
6362 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6363 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6364 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6365 set by 'flash protect' command.
6366 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6367 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6368 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6369 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6370 with the rest of a flash image.
6371 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6372 @end deffn
6373
6374 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6375 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6376 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6377 @end deffn
6378
6379 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6380 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6381 and examine-fail event.
6382 @end deffn
6383
6384 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6385 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6386 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6387 @end deffn
6388
6389 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6390 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6391 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6392 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6393 command completes.
6394 @end deffn
6395
6396 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6397 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6398 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6399 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6400 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6401
6402 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6403 Program Partition command.
6404
6405 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6406 Reset the device after partition setting.
6407
6408 Show partition size:
6409 @example
6410 kinetis nvm_partition info
6411 @end example
6412
6413 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6414 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6415 @example
6416 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6417 @end example
6418
6419 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6420 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6421 @example
6422 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6423 @end example
6424 @end deffn
6425
6426 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6427 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6428 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6429 @end deffn
6430
6431 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6432 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6433 Command disables watchdog timer.
6434 @end deffn
6435 @end deffn
6436
6437 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6438 @cindex kinetis_ke
6439 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6440 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6441 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6442 autoconfigures itself.
6443 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6444
6445 @example
6446 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6447 @end example
6448
6449 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6450 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6451 @end deffn
6452
6453 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6454 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6455 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6456 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6457 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6458 @end deffn
6459
6460 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6461 Command disables watchdog timer.
6462 @end deffn
6463 @end deffn
6464
6465 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6466 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6467 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6468 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6469 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6470
6471 @quotation Note
6472 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6473 driver:
6474 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6475 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6476 @end quotation
6477
6478 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6479 which must appear in the following order:
6480
6481 @itemize
6482 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6483 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6484 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6485 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6486 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6487 LPC43x[2357])
6488 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6489 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6490 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6491 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6492 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6493 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6494 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6495 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6496 at which the core is running
6497 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6498 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6499 @quotation Note
6500 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6501 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6502 However, if you do provide it,
6503 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6504 @end quotation
6505 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6506 ROM IAP entry point.
6507 @end itemize
6508
6509 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6510
6511 @example
6512 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6513 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6514 @end example
6515
6516 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6517 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6518 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6519 @end deffn
6520 @end deffn
6521
6522 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6523 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6524 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6525 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6526 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6527 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6528
6529 @example
6530 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6531 @end example
6532 @end deffn
6533
6534 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6535 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6536 from NXP.
6537
6538 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6539 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6540 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6541 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6542 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6543 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6544 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6545 you start the PLL.
6546
6547 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6548
6549 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6550 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6551 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6552
6553 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6554 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6555 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6556 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6557 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6558 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6559 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6560
6561 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6562 @example
6563 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6564 @end example
6565
6566 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6567 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6568 @code{flash banks} command.
6569
6570 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6571 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6572 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6573 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6574 a known signature.
6575 Example:
6576 @example
6577 lpc2900 signature 0
6578 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6579 @end example
6580 @end deffn
6581
6582 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6583 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6584 saves it to a file in binary format.
6585 Example:
6586 @example
6587 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6588 @end example
6589 @end deffn
6590
6591 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6592 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6593 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6594 command:
6595
6596 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6597 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6598 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6599 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6600
6601 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6602 Example:
6603 @example
6604 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6605 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6606 @end example
6607 @end deffn
6608
6609 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6610 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6611 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6612 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6613 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6614 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6615 912 bytes.
6616 @quotation Attention
6617 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6618 @end quotation
6619 Example:
6620 @example
6621 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6622 @end example
6623 @end deffn
6624
6625 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6626 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6627 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6628 after the next power cycle.
6629 @quotation Attention
6630 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6631 @end quotation
6632 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6633 Example:
6634 @example
6635 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6636 flash info 0
6637 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6638 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6639 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6640 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6641 @end example
6642 @end deffn
6643
6644 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6645 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6646 effective after the next power cycle.
6647 @quotation Attention
6648 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6649 @end quotation
6650 Examples:
6651 @example
6652 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6653 @end example
6654 @end deffn
6655 @end deffn
6656
6657 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6658 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6659 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6660 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6661
6662 @example
6663 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6664 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6665 @end example
6666
6667 @itemize @bullet
6668 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6669 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6670 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6671 @end itemize
6672
6673 Example usage:
6674 @example
6675 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6676 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6677 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6678 @} else @{
6679 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6680 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6681 @}
6682 @end example
6683 @end deffn
6684
6685 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6686 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6687 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6688 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6689 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6690 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6691
6692 @example
6693 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6694 @end example
6695
6696 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6697 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6698 only the main program flash.
6699
6700 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6701 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6702 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6703 @end deffn
6704
6705 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6706 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6707 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6708 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6709
6710 To erase and program the BSL:
6711 @example
6712 msp432 bsl unlock
6713 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6714 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6715 msp432 bsl lock
6716 @end example
6717 @end deffn
6718 @end deffn
6719
6720 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6721 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6722 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6723 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6724 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6725 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6726 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6727 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6728 also have division into regions: main and info.
6729 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6730 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6731
6732 @example
6733 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6734 @end example
6735
6736 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6737
6738 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6739 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6740 @end deffn
6741
6742 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6743 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6744 @end deffn
6745
6746 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6747 Erase all userflash including info region.
6748 @end deffn
6749
6750 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6751 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6752 @end deffn
6753
6754 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6755 Check sectors protect.
6756 @end deffn
6757
6758 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6759 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6760 @end deffn
6761
6762 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6763 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6764 @end deffn
6765
6766 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6767 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6768 @end deffn
6769
6770 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6771 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6772 @end deffn
6773
6774 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6775 Show information about flash driver.
6776 @end deffn
6777
6778 @end deffn
6779
6780 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6781 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6782 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6783 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6784 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6785
6786 @example
6787 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6788 @end example
6789
6790 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6791
6792 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6793 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6794 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6795 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6796 code.
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6800 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6801 @end deffn
6802
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6806 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6807 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6808
6809 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6810 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6811 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6812 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6813
6814 @example
6815 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6816 @end example
6817 @end deffn
6818
6819 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6820 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6821 and integrate flash memory.
6822
6823 @example
6824 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6825 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6826 @end example
6827
6828 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6829 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6830 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6831 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6832 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6833 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6834 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6835 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6836 @end deffn
6837 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6838 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6839 This will remove any Code Protection.
6840 @end deffn
6841 @end deffn
6842
6843 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6844 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6845 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6846 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6847 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6848
6849 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6850 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6851
6852 @example
6853 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6854 @end example
6855
6856 psoc4-specific commands
6857 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6858 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6859
6860 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6861 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6862
6863 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6864 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6865 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6866
6867 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6868 @end deffn
6869
6870 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6871 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6872
6873 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6874 @end deffn
6875 @end deffn
6876
6877 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6878 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6879 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6880 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6881 apart from the base address.
6882
6883 @example
6884 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6885 @end example
6886
6887 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6888 @quotation Attention
6889 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6890 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6891 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6892 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6893 @end quotation
6894
6895 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6896
6897 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6898 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6899 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6900 @end deffn
6901 @end deffn
6902
6903 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6904 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6905 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6906 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6907 apart from the base address.
6908
6909 @example
6910 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6911 $_TARGETNAME
6912 @end example
6913 @end deffn
6914
6915 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6916 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6917 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6918 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6919
6920 @example
6921 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6922 @end example
6923
6924 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6925
6926 @itemize
6927 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6928 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6929 @end itemize
6930
6931 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6932
6933 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6934 @quotation Attention
6935 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6936 after successful write.
6937 @end quotation
6938 @end deffn
6939
6940 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6941 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6942 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6943 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6944
6945 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6946 @itemize @bullet
6947 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6948 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6949 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6950 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6951 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6952 row size: 512 bytes.
6953 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6954 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6955 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6956 operation will erase row automatically.
6957 @end itemize
6958
6959 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6960 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6961
6962 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6963
6964 @example
6965 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6966 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6967 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6968 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6969 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6970 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6971 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6972 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6973 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6974 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6975 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6976 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6977
6978 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6979 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6980 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6981 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6982 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6983 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6984 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6985 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6986 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6987 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6988 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6989 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6990 @end example
6991
6992 psoc6-specific commands
6993 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
6994 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6995 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6996 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6997 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6998 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6999 @end deffn
7000
7001 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7002 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7003 by @command{flash banks}.
7004 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7005 @end deffn
7006 @end deffn
7007
7008 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7009 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7010 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7011 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7012 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7013
7014 @example
7015 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7016 @end example
7017 @end deffn
7018
7019 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7020 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7021 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7022 and SWD interface.
7023 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7024 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7025
7026 @example
7027 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7028 @end example
7029
7030 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7031
7032 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7033 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7034 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7035 @end deffn
7036
7037 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7038 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7039 @end deffn
7040 @end deffn
7041
7042 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7043 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7044 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7045 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7046 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7047
7048 @example
7049 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7050 @end example
7051
7052 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7053 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7054 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7055 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7056 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7057 disabled.
7058
7059 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7060 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7061 @quotation Warning
7062 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7063 applied to all of them.
7064 @end quotation
7065 @end deffn
7066 @end deffn
7067
7068 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7069 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7070 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0 and GD32F3x0 microcontroller
7071 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
7072 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7073 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7074
7075 @example
7076 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7077 @end example
7078
7079 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7080 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7081 the flash driver.
7082
7083 @example
7084 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7085 @end example
7086
7087 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7088 as per the following example.
7089 @example
7090 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7091 @end example
7092
7093 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7094
7095 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7096 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7097 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7098 @end deffn
7099
7100 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7101 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7102 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7103 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7104 @end deffn
7105
7106 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7107 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7108 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7109 @end deffn
7110
7111 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7112 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7113 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7114 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7115 @end deffn
7116
7117 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7118 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7119 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7120 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7121 @end deffn
7122
7123 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7124 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7125 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7126 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7127 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7128 @end deffn
7129 @end deffn
7130
7131 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7132 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7133 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7134 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7135 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7136
7137 @example
7138 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7139 @end example
7140
7141 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7142 as per the following example.
7143 @example
7144 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7145 @end example
7146
7147 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7148 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7149 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7150 @end deffn
7151
7152 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7153 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7154 the flash driver.
7155
7156 @example
7157 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7158 @end example
7159
7160 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7161
7162 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7163 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7164 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7165 @end deffn
7166
7167 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7168 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7169 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7173 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7174 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7175 @end deffn
7176
7177 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7178 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7179 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7180 @end deffn
7181
7182 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7183 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7184 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7185 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7186 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7187 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7191 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7192 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7193 @end deffn
7194 @end deffn
7195
7196 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7197 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7198 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7199 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7200 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7201
7202 @example
7203 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7204 @end example
7205
7206 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7207 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7208 the flash driver.
7209
7210 @example
7211 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7212 @end example
7213
7214 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7215
7216 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7217 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7218 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7219 @end deffn
7220
7221 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7222 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7223 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7224 @end deffn
7225
7226 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7227 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7228 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7229 @end deffn
7230
7231 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7232 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7233 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7234 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7235 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7236
7237 Example usage:
7238 @example
7239 # read OPTSR_CUR
7240 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7241 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7242 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7243 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7244 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7245 @end example
7246 @end deffn
7247
7248 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7249 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7250 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7251 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7252 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7253 will be touched).
7254
7255 Example usage:
7256 @example
7257 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7258 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7259 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7260 @end example
7261 @end deffn
7262 @end deffn
7263
7264 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7265 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7266 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7267 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7268 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7269
7270 @example
7271 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7272 @end example
7273
7274 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7275 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7276 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7277 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7278 second bank.
7279
7280 @example
7281 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7282 @end example
7283
7284 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7285
7286 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7287 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7288 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7289 @end deffn
7290
7291 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7292 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7293 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7294 @end deffn
7295
7296 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7297 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7298 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7299 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7300 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7301 @end deffn
7302 @end deffn
7303
7304 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7305 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7306 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7307 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7308 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7309 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7310
7311 @example
7312 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7313 @end example
7314
7315 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7316 as per the following example.
7317 @example
7318 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7319 @end example
7320
7321 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7322 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7323 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7324 @end deffn
7325
7326 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7327 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7328 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7329 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7330
7331 @example
7332 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7333 @end example
7334
7335 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7336
7337 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7338 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7339 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7340 @end deffn
7341
7342 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7343 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7344 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7345 @end deffn
7346
7347 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7348 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7349 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7350 @end deffn
7351
7352 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7353 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7354 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7355 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7356
7357 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7358 @example
7359 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7360 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7361 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7362 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7363 @end example
7364
7365 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7366 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7367 @end deffn
7368
7369 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7370 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7371 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7372 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7373 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7374
7375 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7376 @example
7377 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7378 @end example
7379
7380 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7381 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7382 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7383 @end deffn
7384
7385 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7386 List the protected areas using WRP.
7387 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7388 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7389 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7390
7391 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7392 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7393 in single or dual-banks mode.
7394 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7395 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7396
7397 @end deffn
7398
7399 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7400 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7401 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7402 @end deffn
7403 @end deffn
7404
7405 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7406 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7407 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7408 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7409 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7410
7411 @example
7412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7413 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7414 @end example
7415
7416 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7417 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7418 for the specified flash bank.
7419 @end deffn
7420 @end deffn
7421
7422 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7423 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7424 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7425 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7426 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7427
7428 @example
7429 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7430 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7431 @end example
7432
7433 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7434 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7435 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7436
7437 @itemize @bullet
7438 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7439 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7440 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7441 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7442 @end itemize
7443 @end deffn
7444
7445 @end deffn
7446
7447 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7448 @cindex str9xpec
7449
7450 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7451 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7452 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7453 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7454
7455 Here is some background info to help
7456 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7457 the str9:
7458 @enumerate
7459 @item
7460 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7461 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7462 @item
7463 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7464 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7465 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7466 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7467 @end enumerate
7468
7469 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7470 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7471 configured for flash bank 0.
7472 @example
7473 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7474 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7475 adapter assert srst
7476 # turn off target polling
7477 poll off
7478 # disable str9 core
7479 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7480 # read option bytes
7481 str9xpec options_read 0
7482 # re-enable str9 core
7483 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7484 poll on
7485 reset halt
7486 @end example
7487 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7488 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7489 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7490 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7491
7492 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7493
7494 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7495 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7496 @end deffn
7497
7498 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7499 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7500 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7501 @end deffn
7502
7503 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7504 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7505 erase the device.
7506 @end deffn
7507
7508 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7509 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7510 @end deffn
7511
7512 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7513 Configure str9 boot bank.
7514 @end deffn
7515
7516 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7517 Configure str9 lvd source.
7518 @end deffn
7519
7520 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7521 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7522 @end deffn
7523
7524 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7525 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7526 @end deffn
7527
7528 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7529 Read str9 option bytes.
7530 @end deffn
7531
7532 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7533 Write str9 option bytes.
7534 @end deffn
7535
7536 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7537 unlock str9 device.
7538 @end deffn
7539
7540 @end deffn
7541
7542 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7543 @cindex swm050
7544 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7545
7546 @example
7547 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7548 @end example
7549
7550 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7551
7552 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7553 Erases the entire flash bank.
7554 @end deffn
7555
7556 @end deffn
7557
7558
7559 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7560 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7561 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7562 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7563
7564 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7565
7566 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7567 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7568 @end deffn
7569
7570 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7571 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7572 @end deffn
7573
7574 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7575 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7576 the flash clock.
7577 @end deffn
7578 @end deffn
7579
7580 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7581 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7582 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7583 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7584 correct bank config.
7585
7586 @example
7587 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7588 @end example
7589 @end deffn
7590
7591 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7592 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7593 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7597 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7598 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7599
7600 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7601
7602 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7603 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7604 @end deffn
7605
7606 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7607 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7608 @end deffn
7609
7610 @end deffn
7611
7612 @section NAND Flash Commands
7613 @cindex NAND
7614
7615 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7616 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7617 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7618
7619 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7620 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7621 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7622 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7623 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7624 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7625
7626 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7627 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7628 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7629 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7630 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7631 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7632 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7633 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7634 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7635 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7636
7637 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7638 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7639 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7640 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7641 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7642 every 512 bytes of data.
7643
7644 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7645 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7646 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7647 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7648 ECC mode is used.
7649
7650 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7651 @enumerate
7652 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7653 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7654 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7655 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7656 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7657 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7658 to access that device.
7659 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7660 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7661 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7662 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7663 de-brick a board.
7664 @end enumerate
7665
7666 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7667 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7668 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7669 are only 32 bits wide.
7670 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7671 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7672 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7673 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7674
7675 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7676 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7677 @cindex NAND configuration
7678
7679 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7680 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7681 OpenOCD has initialized.
7682
7683 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7684 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7685 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7686 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7687 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7688 they were a single (larger) device.
7689 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7690 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7691
7692 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7693 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7694 configuration files, not interactively.
7695
7696 @itemize @bullet
7697 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7698 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7699 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7700 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7701 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7702 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7703 commands to the NAND controller.
7704 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7705 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7706 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7707 for more information.
7708 @end itemize
7709 @end deffn
7710
7711 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7712 Prints a summary of each device declared
7713 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7714 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7715 @example
7716 > nand list
7717 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7718 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7719 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7720 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7721 >
7722 @end example
7723 @end deffn
7724
7725 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7726 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7727 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7728 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7729 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7730 it with most other NAND commands.
7731 @end deffn
7732
7733 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7734
7735 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7736 @cindex NAND reading
7737 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7738 starting at the specified offset.
7739 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7740
7741 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7742 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7743
7744 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7745 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7746 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7747
7748 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7749 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7750 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7751 method which handled that error correction.
7752
7753 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7754 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7755 @itemize @bullet
7756 @item no oob_* parameter
7757 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7758 @item @code{oob_raw}
7759 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7760 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7761 spare areas associated with each data page.
7762 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7763 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7764 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7765 @item @code{oob_only}
7766 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7767 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7768 spare areas associated with each data page.
7769 @end itemize
7770 @end deffn
7771
7772 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7773 @cindex NAND erasing
7774 @cindex NAND programming
7775 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7776 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7777 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7778 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7779 If those parameters are not specified,
7780 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7781 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7782
7783 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7784 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7785 block marker.
7786 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7787 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7788 @end deffn
7789
7790 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7791 @cindex NAND writing
7792 @cindex NAND programming
7793 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7794 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7795 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7796 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7797
7798 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7799 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7800
7801 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7802 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7803 past the end of the device.
7804 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7805 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7806 if that's being written.)
7807
7808 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7809 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7810 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7811
7812 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7813 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7814 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7815 @itemize @bullet
7816 @item no oob_* parameter
7817 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7818 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7819 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7820 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7821 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7822 @item @code{oob_only}
7823 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7824 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7825 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7826 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7827 @item @code{oob_raw}
7828 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7829 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7830 un-altered OOB.
7831 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7832 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7833 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7834 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7835 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7836 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7837 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7838 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7839 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7840 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7841 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7842 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7843 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7844 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7845 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7846 @end itemize
7847 @end deffn
7848
7849 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7850 @cindex NAND verification
7851 @cindex NAND programming
7852 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7853 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7854 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7855
7856 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7857 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7858
7859 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7860 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7861 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7862 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7863 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7864
7865 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7866 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7867 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7868
7869 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7870 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7871 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7872 be removed in a future release.
7873 @end deffn
7874
7875 @subsection Other NAND commands
7876 @cindex NAND other commands
7877
7878 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7879 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7880 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7881 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7882 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7883 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7884 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7885 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7886
7887 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7888 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7889 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7890 @end deffn
7891
7892 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7893 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7894 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7895 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7896 status for each block.
7897 @end deffn
7898
7899 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7900 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7901 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7902
7903 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7904 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7905 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7906 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7907 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7908
7909 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7910 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7911 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7912 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7913 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7914 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7915 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7916 @end deffn
7917
7918 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7919 @subsection NAND Driver List
7920 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7921 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7922 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7923
7924 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7925 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7926 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7927 address of the ECC controller.
7928 @example
7929 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7930 @end example
7931 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7932 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7933 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7934 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7935 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7936 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7937 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7938 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7939 @end deffn
7940 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7941 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7942 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7943 @end deffn
7944
7945 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7946 properly configured for input or output.
7947 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7948 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7949 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7950 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7951 @end deffn
7952 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7953 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7954 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7955 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7956 @end deffn
7957 @end deffn
7958
7959 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
7960 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7961 chips from Texas Instruments.
7962 It takes three extra parameters:
7963 address of the NAND chip;
7964 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7965 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7966 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7967 @example
7968 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7969 @end example
7970 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7971 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7972 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7973 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7974 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7975 @end deffn
7976
7977 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
7978 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7979 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7980 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7981 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7982 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7983 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7984 @end deffn
7985
7986 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7987 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7988 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7989 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7990 @end deffn
7991 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7992
7993 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
7994 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7995 should work for this chip as well.
7996 @end deffn
7997
7998 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
7999 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8000 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8001 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8002 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8003 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8004 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8005 @example
8006 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8007 @end example
8008 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8009 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8010 without parameter query status.
8011 @end deffn
8012 @end deffn
8013
8014 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8015 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8016 parameter: the address of the controller.
8017 @example
8018 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8019 @end example
8020 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8021 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8022 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8023 change any behavior.
8024 @end deffn
8025
8026 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8027 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8028 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8029 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8030 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8031 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8032 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8033 specialized commands.
8034 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8035 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8036 change any behavior.
8037 @end deffn
8038
8039 @node Flash Programming
8040 @chapter Flash Programming
8041
8042 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8043 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8044 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8045
8046 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8047 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8048
8049 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8050 @enumerate
8051 @item 'init' is executed.
8052 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8053 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8054 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8055 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8056 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8057 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8058 @end enumerate
8059
8060 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8061
8062 @example
8063 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8064 # are optional parameters
8065 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8066 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8067
8068 # binary files need the flash address passing
8069 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8070 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8071 @end example
8072
8073 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8074 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8075 @cindex PLD
8076 @cindex FPGA
8077
8078 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8079 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8080 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8081 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8082 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8083 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8084 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8085
8086 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8087
8088 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8089 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8090 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8091
8092 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8093 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8094
8095 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8096 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8097 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8098 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8099 behavior.
8100 @end deffn
8101
8102 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8103 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8104 @end deffn
8105
8106 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8107 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8108 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8109 @end deffn
8110
8111 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8112
8113 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8114 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8115 that particular type of PLD.
8116
8117 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8118 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8119 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8120
8121 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8122 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8123 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8124
8125 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8126 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8127 for FPGA @var{num}.
8128 @end deffn
8129 @end deffn
8130
8131 @node General Commands
8132 @chapter General Commands
8133 @cindex commands
8134
8135 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8136 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8137 commands are documented elsewhere.
8138
8139 Intent:
8140 @itemize @bullet
8141 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8142 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8143 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8144 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8145
8146 @item @b{From the human}
8147 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8148 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8149
8150 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8151 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8152 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8153
8154 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8155 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8156 port is 5555.
8157 @end itemize
8158
8159
8160 @section Server Commands
8161
8162 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8163 Exits the current telnet session.
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8167 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8168 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8169 Not every command provides helptext.
8170
8171 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8172 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8173 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8174 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8175 @end deffn
8176
8177 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8178 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8179 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8180 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8181 Useful in connection with script files
8182 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8183 @end deffn
8184
8185 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8186 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8187 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8188 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8189
8190 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8191 @example
8192 # redefine shutdown
8193 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8194 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8195 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8196 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8197 original_shutdown
8198 @}
8199 @end example
8200 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8201 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8202 @end deffn
8203
8204 @anchor{debuglevel}
8205 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8206 @cindex message level
8207 Display debug level.
8208 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8209 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8210 Level 0 is error messages only;
8211 level 1 adds warnings;
8212 level 2 adds informational messages;
8213 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8214 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8215 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8216 the command line along with the location of that log
8217 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8218 @xref{Running}.
8219 @end deffn
8220
8221 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8222 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8223 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8224 @example
8225 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8226 @end example
8227 @end deffn
8228
8229 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8230 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8231 the default log output channel is stderr.
8232 @end deffn
8233
8234 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8235 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8236 @end deffn
8237
8238 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8239 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8240 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8241 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8242 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8243 @end deffn
8244
8245 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8246 @section Target State handling
8247 @cindex reset
8248 @cindex halt
8249 @cindex target initialization
8250
8251 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8252 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8253 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8254 a current target which is used to perform the
8255 various operations. The current target may be changed
8256 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8257 target which should become current.
8258
8259 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8260 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8261 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8262 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8263 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8264
8265 @emph{With no arguments}:
8266 list all available registers for the current target,
8267 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8268 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8269 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8270 are flagged as such.
8271
8272 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8273 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8274 bypassing any internal cache.
8275
8276 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8277 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8278 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8279 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8280 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8281 relevant module will flush such values.
8282
8283 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8284 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8285
8286 @example
8287 > reg
8288 ===== ARM registers
8289 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8290 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8291 (2) r2 (/32)
8292 ...
8293 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8294 >
8295 @end example
8296 @end deffn
8297
8298 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8299 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8300 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8301 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8302 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8303 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8304 (and enter debug mode).
8305 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8306
8307 @quotation Warning
8308 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8309 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8310 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8311 power mode by gating the core clock;
8312 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8313
8314 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8315 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8316 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8317 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8318 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8319 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8320
8321 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8322 work with a JTAG debugger.
8323 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8324 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8325 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8326 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8327 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8328 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8329 @end quotation
8330
8331 @end deffn
8332
8333 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8334 Resume the target at its current code position,
8335 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8336 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8337 @end deffn
8338
8339 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8340 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8341 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8342 @end deffn
8343
8344 @anchor{resetcommand}
8345 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8346 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8347 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8348 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8349 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8350 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8351 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8352
8353 The optional parameter specifies what should
8354 happen after the reset.
8355 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8356 The other options will not work on all systems.
8357 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8358
8359 @itemize @minus
8360 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8361 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8362 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8363 @end itemize
8364 @end deffn
8365
8366 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8367 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8368 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8369 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8370 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8371 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8372 state.
8373 @end deffn
8374
8375 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8376 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8377 Set values of reset signals.
8378 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8379 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8380 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8381 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8382
8383 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8384 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8385 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8386 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8387 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8388 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8389 the signal will not be modified.
8390
8391 @quotation Note
8392 TRST is specially handled.
8393 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8394 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8395 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8396 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8397 instead of the TRST signal.
8398 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8399 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8400 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8401 with handlers for that event.
8402 @end quotation
8403 @end deffn
8404
8405 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8406 @section Memory access commands
8407 @cindex memory access
8408
8409 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8410 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8411 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8412 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8413
8414 @enumerate
8415 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8416 to change the current target.
8417 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8418 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8419 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8420 @end enumerate
8421
8422 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8423 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8424 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8425 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8426 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8427 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8428 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8429 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8430 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8431 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8432 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8433 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8434 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8435 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8436 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8437 @end deffn
8438
8439 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8440 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8441 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8442 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8443 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8444 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8445 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8446 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8447 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8448 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8449 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8450 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8451 @end deffn
8452
8453 @anchor{imageaccess}
8454 @section Image loading commands
8455 @cindex image loading
8456 @cindex image dumping
8457
8458 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8459 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8460 binary file named @var{filename}.
8461 @end deffn
8462
8463 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8464 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8465 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8466 @end deffn
8467
8468 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8469 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8470 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8471 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8472 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8473 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8474 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8475 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8476 separately.
8477 @end deffn
8478
8479 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8480 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8481 The file format may optionally be specified
8482 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8483 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8484 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8485 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8486 @example
8487 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8488 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8489 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8490 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8491 $address $length
8492 @}
8493 @end example
8494 @end deffn
8495
8496 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8497 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8498 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8499 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8500 The file format may optionally be specified
8501 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8502 @end deffn
8503
8504 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8505 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8506 The file format may optionally be specified
8507 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8508 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8509 @end deffn
8510
8511 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8512 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8513 The file format may optionally be specified
8514 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8515 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8516 @end deffn
8517
8518
8519 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8520 @cindex breakpoint
8521 @cindex watchpoint
8522
8523 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8524 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8525 watchpoints.
8526 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8527
8528 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8529 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8530 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8531 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8532 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8533 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8534
8535 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8536 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8537 @end deffn
8538
8539 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8540 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8541 @end deffn
8542
8543 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8544 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8545 @end deffn
8546
8547 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8548 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8549 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8550 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8551 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8552 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8553 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8554 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8555 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8556 @end deffn
8557
8558
8559 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8560
8561 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8562 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8563 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8564 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8565 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8566 running, can be used.
8567 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8568 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8569 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8570
8571 @quotation Note
8572 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8573 @end quotation
8574
8575 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8576 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8577 communication, respectively.
8578
8579 @quotation Note
8580 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8581 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8582 example.
8583 @end quotation
8584
8585 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8586 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8587 of TCP/IP connections.
8588
8589 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8590 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8591 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8592 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8593 @var{size} bytes.
8594 @end deffn
8595
8596 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8597 Start RTT.
8598 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8599 @end deffn
8600
8601 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8602 Stop RTT.
8603 @end deffn
8604
8605 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8606 Display the polling interval.
8607 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8608 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8609 checked for new data.
8610 @end deffn
8611
8612 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8613 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8614 @end deffn
8615
8616 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8617 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8618 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8619 @end deffn
8620
8621 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8622 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8623 @end deffn
8624
8625 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8626 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8627 @end deffn
8628
8629 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8630 on the target device.
8631
8632 @example
8633 resume
8634
8635 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8636 rtt start
8637
8638 rtt server start 9090 0
8639 @end example
8640
8641 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8642 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8643 TCP/IP port 9090.
8644
8645
8646 @section Misc Commands
8647
8648 @cindex profiling
8649 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8650 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8651 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8652 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8653 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8654 limit the address range.
8655 @end deffn
8656
8657 @deffn {Command} {version}
8658 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8659 @end deffn
8660
8661 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8662 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8663 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8664 @end deffn
8665
8666 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8667 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8668 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8669 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8670
8671 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8672 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8673 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8674 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8675
8676 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8677 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8678 @cindex tracing
8679 @cindex ETM
8680 @cindex ETB
8681
8682 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8683 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8684 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8685
8686 @itemize
8687 @item
8688 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8689 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8690 supports such an interface.
8691 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8692 and trace port support.)
8693 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8694 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8695 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8696 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8697 in the board-specific configuration file.
8698 @item
8699 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8700 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8701 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8702 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8703 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8704 @end itemize
8705
8706 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8707
8708 @quotation Issues
8709 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8710 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8711
8712 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8713 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8714 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8715 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8716 dummy trace port driver}.
8717
8718 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8719 as well as tracing only during specific states
8720 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8721
8722 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8723 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8724 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8725 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8726 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8727
8728 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8729 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8730 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8731 this original style of JTAG access.
8732 @end quotation
8733
8734 @subsection ETM Configuration
8735 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8736
8737 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8738 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8739 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8740
8741 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8742 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8743 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8744 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8745 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8746 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8747 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8748 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8749 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8750
8751 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8752 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8753 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8754
8755 @quotation Warning
8756 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8757 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8758 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8759 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8760 @end quotation
8761
8762 @quotation Note
8763 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8764 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8765 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8766 what CPU activities are traced.
8767 @end quotation
8768 @end deffn
8769
8770 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8771 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8772 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8773 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8774 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8775 @end deffn
8776
8777 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8778 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8779 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8780 Did trace data overflow?
8781 Was it triggered?
8782 @end deffn
8783
8784 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8785 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8786 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8787 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8788 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8789
8790 @itemize
8791 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8792 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8793 The value is one of
8794 @option{none} (save nothing),
8795 @option{data} (save data),
8796 @option{address} (save addresses),
8797 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8798 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8799 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8800 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8801 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8802 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8803 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8804 trace stream without an image of the code.
8805 @end itemize
8806 @end deffn
8807
8808 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8809 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8810 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8811 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8812 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8813
8814 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8815 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8816 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8817 @end deffn
8818
8819 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8820
8821 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8822 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8823 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8824
8825 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8826 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8827 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8828 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8829 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8830 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8831 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8832
8833 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8834
8835 @itemize
8836 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8837 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8838 for instruction access within that function's body.
8839 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8840 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8841 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8842 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8843 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8844 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8845 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8846 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8847 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8848 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8849 @item @emph{... more}
8850 @end itemize
8851
8852 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8853 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8854
8855 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8856 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8857 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8858 @end deffn
8859
8860 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8861 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8862 @end deffn
8863
8864 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8865 Opens an image file.
8866 @end deffn
8867
8868 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8869 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8870 @end deffn
8871
8872 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8873 Starts trace data collection.
8874 @end deffn
8875
8876 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8877 Stops trace data collection.
8878 @end deffn
8879
8880 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8881 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8882
8883 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8884
8885 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8886 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8887 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8888 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8889 any trace data collection.}
8890 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8891 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8892 @end deffn
8893 @end deffn
8894
8895 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8896 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8897 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8898 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8899 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8900 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8901 @end deffn
8902 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8903 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8904 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8905 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8906 trace trigger becomes active.
8907
8908 @itemize
8909 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8910 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8911 afterwards.
8912 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8913 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8914 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8915 what caused that event to happen.
8916 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8917 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8918 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8919 how the event caused trouble.
8920 @end itemize
8921 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8922 @end deffn
8923
8924 @end deffn
8925
8926 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8927 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8928 @cindex CTI
8929
8930 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8931 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8932 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8933 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8934 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8935 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8936
8937 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8938 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8939 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8940 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8941 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8942 including additional configuration.
8943 @end deffn
8944
8945 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8946 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8947 @end deffn
8948
8949 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
8950 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8951 @end deffn
8952
8953 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8954 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8955 @end deffn
8956
8957 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8958 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8959 @end deffn
8960
8961 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8962 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8963 @end deffn
8964
8965 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8966 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8967 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8968 @end deffn
8969
8970 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8971 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8972 of the CTI.
8973 @end deffn
8974
8975 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
8976 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8977 useful in TCL scripting.
8978 @end deffn
8979
8980 @section Generic ARM
8981 @cindex ARM
8982
8983 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8984 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8985 commands that may be available.
8986
8987 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8988 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8989 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8990 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8991 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8992 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8993 @end deffn
8994
8995 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8996 @cindex disassemble
8997 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8998 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8999 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9000 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9001 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9002 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9003 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9004
9005 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9006 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9007 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9008 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9009 with a handful of exceptions.
9010 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9011 @end deffn
9012
9013 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9014 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9015 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9016 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9017 and using the MCR instruction.
9018 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9019 an ARM register.)
9020 @end deffn
9021
9022 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9023 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9024 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9025 and the MRC instruction.
9026 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9027 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9028 an ARM register.)
9029 @end deffn
9030
9031 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9032 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9033 core mode if necessary.
9034 @end deffn
9035
9036 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9037 @cindex ARM semihosting
9038 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9039
9040 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9041 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9042 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9043 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9044 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9045 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9046 @end deffn
9047
9048 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9049 @cindex ARM semihosting
9050 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9051
9052 @example
9053 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9054 @end example
9055
9056 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9057 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9058 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9059 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9060 @end deffn
9061
9062 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9063 @cindex ARM semihosting
9064 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9065 status.
9066
9067 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9068 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9069 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9070 debugger.
9071 @end deffn
9072
9073 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9074 @cindex ARM semihosting
9075 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9076
9077 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9078 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9079 the value returned by the target.
9080
9081 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9082 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9083 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9084 encountering a break.
9085
9086 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9087 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9088 to the debugger.
9089 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9090 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9091 request or equivalent").
9092
9093 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9094 this option (default: disabled).
9095 @end deffn
9096
9097 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9098 @cindex ARMv4
9099 @cindex ARMv5
9100
9101 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9102 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9103 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9104 variant.
9105
9106 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9107 @cindex ARM7
9108 @cindex ARM9
9109
9110 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9111 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9112 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9113 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9114
9115 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9116 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9117 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9118 instead of breakpoints.
9119 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9120
9121 This should be
9122 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9123 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9124 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9125 @end deffn
9126
9127 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9128 @cindex DCC
9129 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9130 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9131 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9132
9133 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9134 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9135 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9136 @end deffn
9137
9138 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9139 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9140 that don't check completion of the operation.
9141 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9142
9143 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9144 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9145 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9146 @end deffn
9147
9148 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9149 @cindex ARM9
9150
9151 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9152 integer processors.
9153 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9154
9155 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9156 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9157 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9158 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9159
9160 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9161 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9162 @cindex vector_catch
9163 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9164 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9165 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9166 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9167 to those hardware vectors.
9168
9169 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9170 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9171 vector catch hardware to intercept
9172 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9173 @option{none} of them,
9174 or a list with one or more of the following:
9175 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9176 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9177 @end deffn
9178
9179 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9180 @cindex ARM920T
9181
9182 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9183 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9184 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9185 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9186 and ARM9 commands.
9187
9188 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9189 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9190 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9191 @end deffn
9192
9193 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9194 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9195 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9196 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9197 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9198 (Not all registers can be written.)
9199 @end deffn
9200
9201 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9202 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9203 @end deffn
9204
9205 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9206 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9207 @end deffn
9208
9209 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9210 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9211
9212 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9213 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9214 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9215 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9216 and ARM9 commands.
9217
9218 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9219 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9220
9221 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9222 Print information about the caches found.
9223 @end deffn
9224
9225 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9226 @cindex ARM966E
9227
9228 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9229 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9230 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9231 and ARM9 commands.
9232
9233 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9234 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9235 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9236 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9237 ARM966E-S TRM.
9238 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9239 as required for BIST support.
9240 @end deffn
9241
9242 @subsection XScale specific commands
9243 @cindex XScale
9244
9245 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9246
9247 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9248 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9249 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9250 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9251 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9252 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9253 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9254
9255 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9256 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9257 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9258 the mini-IC.
9259
9260 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9261 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9262 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9263 code layout in memory:
9264 @example
9265 _vectors:
9266 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9267 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9268 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9269 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9270 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9271 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9272 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9273 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9274 .org 0x100
9275 .long real_reset_vector
9276 .long real_ui_handler
9277 .long real_swi_handler
9278 .long real_pf_abort
9279 .long real_data_abort
9280 .long 0 /* unused */
9281 .long real_irq_handler
9282 .long real_fiq_handler
9283 @end example
9284
9285 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9286 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9287 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9288 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9289 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9290 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9291 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9292 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9293 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9294 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9295 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9296 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9297 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9298 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9299 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9300 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9301 software.
9302
9303 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9304 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9305 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9306 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9307
9308 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9309 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9310 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9311 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9312 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9313 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9314 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9315 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9316 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9317
9318 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9319 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9320
9321 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9322 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9323 @end deffn
9324
9325 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9326 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9327 @end deffn
9328
9329 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9330 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9331 @end deffn
9332
9333 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9334 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9335 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9336 @end deffn
9337
9338 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9339 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9340 @end deffn
9341
9342 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9343 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9344 @end deffn
9345
9346 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9347 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9348 @end deffn
9349
9350 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9351 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9352 @end deffn
9353
9354 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9355 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9356 @end deffn
9357
9358 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9359 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9360 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9361 and modifying how it is emptied.
9362 @end deffn
9363
9364 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9365 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9366 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9367 The image @var{type} may be one of
9368 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9369 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9370 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9371 @end deffn
9372
9373 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9374 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9375 @cindex vector_catch
9376 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9377 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9378
9379 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9380 @example
9381 0x01 Trap Reset
9382 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9383 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9384 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9385 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9386 0x20 reserved
9387 0x40 Trap IRQ
9388 0x80 Trap FIQ
9389 @end example
9390 @end deffn
9391
9392 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9393 @cindex vector_table
9394
9395 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9396 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9397 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9398 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9399 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9400
9401 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9402
9403 @end deffn
9404
9405 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9406 @cindex ARMv6
9407
9408 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9409 @cindex ARM11
9410
9411 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9412 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9413 which is enabled by default.
9414 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9415 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9416 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9417 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9418 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9419 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9420 @end deffn
9421
9422 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9423 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9424 which is enabled by default.
9425 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9426 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9427 @end deffn
9428
9429 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9430 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9431 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9432 they are disabled by default.
9433 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9434 @end deffn
9435
9436 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9437 @cindex vector_catch
9438 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9439 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9440 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9441
9442 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9443 for certain hardware events.
9444 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9445 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9446 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9447 @end deffn
9448
9449 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9450 @cindex ARMv7
9451 @cindex ARMv8
9452
9453 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9454 @cindex Cortex-A
9455
9456 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9457 display information about target caches
9458 @end deffn
9459
9460 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9461 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9462 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9463 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9464 Defaults to 'off'.
9465 @end deffn
9466
9467 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9468 Initialize core debug
9469 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9470 @end deffn
9471
9472 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9473 Display/set the current SMP mode
9474 @end deffn
9475
9476 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9477 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9478 @end deffn
9479
9480 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9481 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9482 @end deffn
9483
9484 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9485 configure l2x cache
9486 @end deffn
9487
9488 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9489 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9490 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9491 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9492 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9493 @end deffn
9494
9495 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9496 @cindex Cortex-R
9497
9498 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r dbginit}
9499 Initialize core debug
9500 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9501 @end deffn
9502
9503 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9504 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9505 @end deffn
9506
9507
9508 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9509 @cindex tracing
9510 @cindex SWO
9511 @cindex SWV
9512 @cindex TPIU
9513
9514 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9515 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9516 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9517 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9518
9519 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9520 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9521 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9522 which causes quite some confusion.
9523 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9524 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9525
9526 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9527 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9528 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9529
9530 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9531 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9532 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9533 @end deffn
9534
9535 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9536 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9537 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9538 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9539
9540 @itemize @bullet
9541 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9542 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9543 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9544 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9545
9546 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9547 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9548 @end itemize
9549 @end deffn
9550
9551 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9552 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9553 @end deffn
9554
9555 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9556 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9557 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9558 at any time after the initialization, too.
9559 @end deffn
9560
9561 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9562 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9563 individually queried, to return its current value.
9564 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9565 @end deffn
9566
9567 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9568 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9569 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9570 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9571
9572 @itemize @bullet
9573 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9574 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9575
9576 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9577 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9578
9579 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9580 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9581
9582 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9583 protocol used for trace data:
9584 @itemize @minus
9585 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9586 data bits (default);
9587 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9588 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9589 @end itemize
9590
9591 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9592 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9593 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9594 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9595 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9596 of the TPIU.
9597
9598 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9599 the destination of the trace data:
9600 @itemize @minus
9601 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9602 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9603 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9604 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9605 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9606 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9607 each connected client;
9608 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9609 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9610 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9611 @end itemize
9612
9613 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9614 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9615 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9616 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9617
9618 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9619 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9620 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9621 maximum supported rate automatically.
9622
9623 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9624 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9625 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9626
9627 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9628 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9629 default value is @var{0}.
9630 @end itemize
9631 @end deffn
9632
9633 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9634 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9635 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9636 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9637 data.
9638 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9639 after the @command{init}.
9640 @end deffn
9641
9642 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9643 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9644 @end deffn
9645
9646
9647
9648 Example usage:
9649 @enumerate
9650 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9651 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9652 enough to:
9653 @example
9654 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9655 ...
9656 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9657 ...
9658 @end example
9659 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9660 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9661 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9662 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9663 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9664 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9665 @example
9666 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9667 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9668 @end example
9669 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9670 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9671 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9672 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9673 @example
9674 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9675 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9676 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9677 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9678 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9679 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9680 @end example
9681 @end enumerate
9682
9683 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9684 @cindex tracing
9685 @cindex SWO
9686 @cindex SWV
9687 @cindex ITM
9688 @cindex ETM
9689
9690 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9691 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9692 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9693 @end deffn
9694
9695 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9696 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9697 @end deffn
9698
9699 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9700 @cindex Cortex-M
9701
9702 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9703 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9704
9705 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9706 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9707 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9708 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9709 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9710 the step command leaves with the core running.
9711
9712 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9713 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9714 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9715 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9716
9717 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9718 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9719 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9720 does.
9721
9722 Default is @option{auto}.
9723 @end deffn
9724
9725 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9726 @cindex vector_catch
9727 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9728 for certain hardware events.
9729
9730 Parameters request interception of
9731 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9732 @option{none} of them,
9733 or one or more of the following:
9734 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9735 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9736 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9737 @option{irq_err},
9738 @option{state_err},
9739 @option{chk_err}, or
9740 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9741 @option{reset}.
9742 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9743 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9744 are mapped to HardFault.
9745 UsageFault checks for
9746 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9747 must also be explicitly enabled.
9748
9749 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9750 @end deffn
9751
9752 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9753 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9754 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9755
9756 @itemize @minus
9757 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9758 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9759 @end itemize
9760
9761 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9762 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9763 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9764 to manually reset the peripherals.
9765 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9766
9767 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9768 instead.
9769 @end deffn
9770
9771 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9772 @cindex ARMv8-A
9773 @cindex aarch64
9774
9775 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9776 Display information about target caches
9777 @end deffn
9778
9779 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9780 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9781 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9782 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9783 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9784 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9785 @end deffn
9786
9787 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9788 @cindex disassemble
9789 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9790 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9791 @end deffn
9792
9793 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9794 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9795 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9796 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9797 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9798 @end deffn
9799
9800 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9801 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9802 @option{on}.
9803 @end deffn
9804
9805 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9806 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9807 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9808 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9809 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9810 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9811 @end deffn
9812
9813 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9814
9815 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9816 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9817
9818 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9819
9820 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9821 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9822 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9823 @end deffn
9824
9825 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9826 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9827 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9828 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9829 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9830 @end deffn
9831
9832 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9833
9834 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9835 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9836 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9837 @end deffn
9838
9839 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9840
9841 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9842 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9843 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9844 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9845 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9846 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9847 can be collected.
9848
9849 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9850 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9851 tooling.
9852
9853 @quotation Issues
9854 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9855 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9856 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9857 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9858
9859 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9860 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9861 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9862 software operation on the CPU.
9863 @end quotation
9864
9865 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9866 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9867 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9868 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9869 @end deffn
9870
9871 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9872 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9873 @end deffn
9874
9875 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9876 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9877 control is disabled.
9878 @end deffn
9879
9880 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9881 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9882 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9883 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9884
9885 Supported trace formats:
9886 @itemize
9887 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9888 timing to be determined.
9889 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9890 addresses.
9891 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9892 @end itemize
9893 @end deffn
9894
9895 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9896 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9897 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9898 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9899
9900 Supported conditions:
9901 @itemize
9902 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9903 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9904 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9905 instruction matches start data and mask.
9906 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9907 instruction matches start data and mask.
9908 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9909 data and mask.
9910 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9911 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9912 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9913 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9914 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9915 @end itemize
9916 @end deffn
9917
9918 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9919 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9920 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9921 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9922
9923 Supported conditions:
9924 @itemize
9925 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9926 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9927 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9928 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9929 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9930 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9931 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9932 data and mask.
9933 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9934 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9935 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9936 @end itemize
9937 @end deffn
9938
9939 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9940 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9941
9942 Supported triggers:
9943 @itemize
9944 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9945 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9946 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9947 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9948 collection.
9949 @end itemize
9950 @end deffn
9951
9952 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9953
9954 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
9955 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9956 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9957 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9958 @end deffn
9959
9960 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
9961 Display trace configuration.
9962 @end deffn
9963
9964 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
9965 Display trace collection status.
9966 @end deffn
9967
9968 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
9969 Start manual trace collection.
9970 @end deffn
9971
9972 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
9973 Stop manual trace collection.
9974 @end deffn
9975
9976 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9977 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9978 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9979 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9980 @option{size} options using DMA.
9981 @end deffn
9982
9983 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9984 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9985 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9986 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9987 @option{size} options using DMA.
9988 @end deffn
9989
9990 @section Intel Architecture
9991
9992 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9993 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9994 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9995 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9996 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9997 @itemize
9998 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9999 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10000 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10001 @end itemize
10002
10003 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10004 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10005 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10006
10007 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10008 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10009 @end deffn
10010
10011 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10012 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10013 @end deffn
10014
10015 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10016 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10017 @end deffn
10018
10019 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10020 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10021 @end deffn
10022
10023 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10024 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10025 @end deffn
10026
10027 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10028 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10029 @end deffn
10030
10031 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10032
10033 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10034 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10035
10036 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10037 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10038 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10039 @end deffn
10040 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10041 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10042
10043 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10044
10045 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10046 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10047 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10048 @end deffn
10049
10050 @subsection Registers commands
10051 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10052 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10053 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10054
10055 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10056
10057 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10058 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10059 and "timer" groups.
10060
10061 @emph{example:}
10062 @example
10063 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10064 @end example
10065
10066
10067 @end deffn
10068 @deffn {Command} {readgroup} (@option{group})
10069 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
10070
10071 @emph{group} can be "system",
10072 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
10073 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
10074 @end deffn
10075
10076 @section RISC-V Architecture
10077
10078 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10079 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10080 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10081 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10082 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10083 implement version 0.11.
10084
10085 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10086
10087 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10088 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10089 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10090
10091 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10092
10093 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10094 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10095 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10096
10097 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10098 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10099 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10100 CSRs.
10101 @end deffn
10102
10103 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10104 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10105 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10106 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10107 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10108 This command must be executed before `init`.
10109 @end deffn
10110
10111 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10112 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10113 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10114 @end deffn
10115
10116 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10117 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10118 deasserted.
10119 @end deffn
10120
10121 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10122 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10123 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10124 @end deffn
10125
10126 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10127 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10128 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10129 @end deffn
10130
10131 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10132 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10133 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10134 on physical memory.
10135 @end deffn
10136
10137 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10138 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10139 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10140 performed on physical memory.
10141 @end deffn
10142
10143 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10144 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10145 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10146 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10147 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10148 race condition problem in your code.
10149
10150 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10151 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10152 @end deffn
10153
10154 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10155 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10156 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10157 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10158 values.
10159
10160 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10161 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10162 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10163 @end deffn
10164
10165 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10166 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10167 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10168 @end deffn
10169
10170 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10171 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10172 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10173 @end deffn
10174
10175 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10176 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10177 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10178 @end deffn
10179
10180 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10181 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10182 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10183 @end deffn
10184
10185 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10186
10187 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10188 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10189 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10190 @example
10191 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10192 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10193 @end example
10194
10195 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10196 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10197 @end deffn
10198
10199 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10200 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10201 @end deffn
10202
10203 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10204
10205 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10206 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10207
10208 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10209 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10210 @end deffn
10211
10212 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10213 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10214 @end deffn
10215
10216 @section ARC Architecture
10217 @cindex ARC
10218
10219 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10220 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10221 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10222 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10223 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10224 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10225 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10226 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10227 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10228 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10229 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10230 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10231 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10232 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10233 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10234
10235
10236 @subsection General ARC commands
10237
10238 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10239
10240 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10241 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10242 arguments:
10243
10244 @itemize @bullet
10245
10246 @item @code{-name} name
10247 @*Name of a register.
10248
10249 @item @code{-num} number
10250 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10251
10252 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10253 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10254
10255 @end itemize
10256
10257 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10258
10259 @itemize @bullet
10260
10261 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10262 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10263 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10264 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10265 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10266 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10267
10268 @item @code{-core}
10269 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10270 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10271 spaces.
10272
10273 @item @code{-bcr}
10274 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10275 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10276 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10277 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10278 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10279
10280 @item @code{-type} type_name
10281 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10282 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10283
10284 @item @code{-g}
10285 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10286 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10287 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10288 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10289 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10290
10291 @end itemize
10292
10293 @end deffn
10294
10295 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10296 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10297 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10298 @end deffn
10299
10300 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10301 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10302 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10303 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10304 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10305 startbit endbit}.
10306 @end deffn
10307
10308 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10309 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10310 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10311 @end deffn
10312
10313 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10314 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10315 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10316 @end deffn
10317
10318 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10319
10320 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10321 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10322 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10323 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10324
10325 @end deffn
10326
10327 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10328 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10329 registers.
10330 @end deffn
10331
10332 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10333 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10334 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10335 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10336
10337 @end deffn
10338
10339 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10340 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10341 registers.
10342 @end deffn
10343
10344 @section STM8 Architecture
10345 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10346 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10347
10348 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10349 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10350
10351 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10352 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10353 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10354 @cindex tracing
10355 @cindex libdcc
10356 @cindex DCC
10357 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10358 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10359 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10360 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10361
10362 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10363 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10364 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10365 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10366 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10367 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10368
10369 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10370 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10371 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10372 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10373 The target being debugged may
10374 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10375 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10376 each supported by a command:
10377
10378 @itemize
10379 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10380 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10381 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10382 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10383
10384 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10385 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10386 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10387
10388 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10389 and then displayed at any time.
10390 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10391
10392 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10393 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10394 @end itemize
10395
10396 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10397 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10398 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10399 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10400 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10401 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10402 does the same thing.
10403
10404 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10405 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10406 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10407 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10408 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10409
10410 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10411 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10412 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10413 @end deffn
10414
10415 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10416 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10417 in the order they triggered.
10418 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10419 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10420 history records.
10421 @end deffn
10422
10423 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10424 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10425 they have been triggered.
10426 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10427 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10428 and associates it with that identifier.
10429
10430 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10431 are not related except by this command.
10432 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10433 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10434 @end deffn
10435
10436
10437 @node JTAG Commands
10438 @chapter JTAG Commands
10439 @cindex JTAG Commands
10440 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10441 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10442 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10443 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10444 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10445
10446 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10447 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10448
10449 @itemize @bullet
10450 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10451 devices such as a CPUs.
10452 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10453 standard state machine (in parallel)
10454 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10455 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10456 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10457 while the reading previous ones.
10458 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10459 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10460 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10461 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10462 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10463 registers.
10464 @end itemize
10465
10466 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10467
10468 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10469 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10470 the order of TAP state transitions.
10471 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10472 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10473 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10474 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10475 these commands are not available.
10476
10477 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10478 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10479 that specify the entire register.
10480 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10481 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10482 The return value holds the original value of each
10483 of those fields.
10484
10485 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10486 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10487 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10488 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10489 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10490
10491 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10492 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10493
10494 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10495 in that state.
10496 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10497 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10498 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10499
10500 @quotation Warning
10501 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10502 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10503 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10504 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10505 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10506 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10507 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10508 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10509 @end quotation
10510 @end deffn
10511
10512 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10513 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10514 This may be used for performance tuning.
10515
10516 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10517 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10518 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10519 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10520 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10521 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10522 @end deffn
10523
10524 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10525 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10526 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10527 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10528 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10529 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10530
10531 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10532 in that state.
10533 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10534 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10535 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10536
10537 @quotation Note
10538 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10539 register values, unlike data register values.
10540 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10541 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10542 @end quotation
10543 @end deffn
10544
10545 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10546 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10547 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10548 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10549 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10550 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10551 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10552 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10553 The final state must also be stable.
10554 @end deffn
10555
10556 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10557 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10558 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10559 Instructions often need some time
10560 to execute before they take effect.
10561 @end deffn
10562
10563 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10564 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10565
10566 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10567 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10568 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10569 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10570 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10571 @end deffn
10572
10573 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10574 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10575 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10576 must also be enabled.
10577 Default is enabled.
10578 @end deffn
10579
10580 @section TAP state names
10581 @cindex TAP state names
10582
10583 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10584 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10585 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10586 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10587
10588 @itemize @bullet
10589 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10590 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10591 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10592 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10593 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10594 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10595 through the data register
10596 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10597 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10598 for update or more shifting
10599 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10600 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10601 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10602 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10603 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10604 through the instruction register
10605 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10606 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10607 for update or more shifting
10608 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10609 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10610 @end itemize
10611
10612 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10613 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10614 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10615 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10616
10617 @itemize @bullet
10618 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10619 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10620 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10621 may not be as expected.
10622 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10623 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10624 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10625 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10626 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10627 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10628 @end itemize
10629
10630 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10631 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10632
10633 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10634 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10635 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10636 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10637
10638 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10639 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10640 @cindex SVF
10641
10642 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10643 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10644 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10645 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10646
10647 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10648 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10649 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10650 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10651
10652 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10653 affect their semantics.
10654
10655 Command options:
10656 @itemize @minus
10657 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10658 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10659 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10660 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10661 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10662 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10663 on the real interface;
10664 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10665 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10666 errors.
10667 @end itemize
10668 @end deffn
10669
10670 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10671 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10672 @cindex XSVF
10673
10674 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10675 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10676 Xilinx devices.
10677 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10678 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10679
10680 @quotation Important
10681 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10682 @end quotation
10683
10684 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10685 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10686 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10687 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10688 that TAP.
10689 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10690 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10691 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10692 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10693 @end deffn
10694
10695 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10696 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10697 after building the software.
10698 You may find them useful:
10699
10700 @itemize
10701 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10702 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10703 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10704 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10705 @end itemize
10706
10707 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10708 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10709 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10710 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10711 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10712 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10713 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10714
10715
10716 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10717 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10718 @cindex IPDBG
10719
10720 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10721 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10722 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10723 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10724 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10725 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10726
10727 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10728 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10729
10730 Command options:
10731 @itemize @bullet
10732 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10733 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10734 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10735 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10736 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10737 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10738 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10739 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10740 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10741 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10742 shift data through vir can be configured.
10743 @end itemize
10744 @end deffn
10745
10746 Examples:
10747 @example
10748 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10749 @end example
10750 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10751 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10752
10753 @example
10754 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10755 @end example
10756 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10757 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10758
10759 @node Utility Commands
10760 @chapter Utility Commands
10761 @cindex Utility Commands
10762
10763 @section RAM testing
10764 @cindex RAM testing
10765
10766 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10767 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10768 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10769 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10770 hardware problems.
10771
10772 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10773 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10774 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10775 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10776
10777 Load the memory testing functions with
10778
10779 @example
10780 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10781 @end example
10782
10783 to get access to the following facilities:
10784
10785 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10786 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10787 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10788 @end deffn
10789
10790 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10791 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10792 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10793 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10794 @end deffn
10795
10796 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10797 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10798 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10799 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10800 @end deffn
10801
10802 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10803 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10804 @end deffn
10805
10806 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10807 @cindex Firmware recovery
10808
10809 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10810 devices recovery with JTAG.
10811
10812 For quickstart instructions run:
10813 @example
10814 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10815 @end example
10816
10817 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10818 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10819 @cindex GDB
10820 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10821 to debug remote targets.
10822 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10823
10824 @itemize
10825 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10826 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10827 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10828 as shown in this chapter.
10829 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10830 that also will probably need to be configured.
10831 @end itemize
10832
10833 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10834 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10835 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10836 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10837 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10838 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10839
10840 @section Connecting to GDB
10841 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10842 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10843 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10844 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10845 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10846
10847 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10848
10849 @enumerate
10850 @item
10851 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10852 @example
10853 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10854 @end example
10855 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10856
10857 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10858 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10859 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10860
10861 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10862 remote command above that becomes:
10863 @example
10864 tar ext :3333
10865 @end example
10866
10867 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10868 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10869 available through the command:
10870 @example
10871 target remote localhost:3333
10872 @end example
10873
10874 @item
10875 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10876 @example
10877 target extended-remote | \
10878 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10879 @end example
10880 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10881 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10882 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10883 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10884 @end enumerate
10885
10886 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10887 GDB command line.
10888
10889 @section Sample GDB session startup
10890
10891 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10892 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10893 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10894 small ARM program.
10895 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10896 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10897
10898 @example
10899 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10900 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10901 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10902 ...
10903 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10904 ...
10905 (gdb) load
10906 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10907 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10908 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10909 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10910 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10911 (gdb) continue
10912 Continuing.
10913 ...
10914 @end example
10915
10916 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10917 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10918 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10919 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10920
10921 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10922
10923 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10924 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10925 packet size and the device's memory map.
10926 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10927 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10928 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10929
10930 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10931 You may need to set those up by hand.
10932 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10933 something like:
10934
10935 @example
10936 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10937 @end example
10938
10939 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10940
10941 @example
10942 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10943 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10944 @end example
10945
10946 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10947 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10948 do not have such restrictions.
10949
10950 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10951 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10952 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10953 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10954
10955 @section Programming using GDB
10956 @cindex Programming using GDB
10957 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10958
10959 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10960 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10961 @example
10962 gdb_memory_map disable
10963 @end example
10964 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10965 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10966 working area.
10967
10968 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10969 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10970 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10971 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10972
10973 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10974 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10975
10976 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10977 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10978 @example
10979 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10980 @end example
10981
10982 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10983 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10984
10985 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10986 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10987 will be used.
10988
10989 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10990 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10991 @example
10992 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10993 @end example
10994 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10995
10996 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10997 can be used.
10998
10999 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11000 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11001 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11002
11003 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11004 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11005 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11006
11007 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11008 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11009 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11010 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11011 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11012 without any intrusion of the target process.
11013
11014 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11015 Place following command after target configuration:
11016 @example
11017 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11018 @end example
11019
11020 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11021 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11022 @example
11023 gdb_memory_map disable
11024 @end example
11025
11026 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11027 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11028 @example
11029 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11030 @end example
11031
11032 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11033 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11034
11035 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11036 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11037 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11038 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11039
11040 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11041 previously shown variables.
11042
11043 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11044 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11045 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11046 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11047 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11048
11049 @section RTOS Support
11050 @cindex RTOS Support
11051 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11052
11053 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11054 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11055
11056 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11057 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11058 GDB commands.
11059
11060 @* An example setup is below:
11061
11062 @example
11063 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11064 @end example
11065
11066 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11067
11068 Currently supported rtos's include:
11069 @itemize @bullet
11070 @item @option{eCos}
11071 @item @option{ThreadX}
11072 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11073 @item @option{linux}
11074 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11075 @item @option{embKernel}
11076 @item @option{mqx}
11077 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11078 @item @option{nuttx}
11079 @item @option{RIOT}
11080 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11081 @item @option{Zephyr}
11082 @end itemize
11083
11084 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11085 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11086
11087 @table @code
11088 @item eCos symbols
11089 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11090 @item ThreadX symbols
11091 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11092 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11093 @raggedright
11094 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11095 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11096 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11097 @end raggedright
11098 @item linux symbols
11099 init_task.
11100 @item ChibiOS symbols
11101 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11102 @item embKernel symbols
11103 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11104 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11105 @item mqx symbols
11106 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11107 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11108 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11109 @item nuttx symbols
11110 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11111 @item RIOT symbols
11112 @raggedright
11113 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11114 _tcb_name_offset.
11115 @end raggedright
11116 @item Zephyr symbols
11117 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11118 @end table
11119
11120 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11121 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11122
11123 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11124 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11125
11126 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11127 along with the project:
11128
11129 @table @code
11130 @item FreeRTOS
11131 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11132 @item uC/OS-III
11133 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11134 @end table
11135
11136 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11137 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11138 @cindex SMP
11139 @cindex RTOS
11140 @cindex hwthread
11141 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11142 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11143 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11144 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11145 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11146 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11147 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11148 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11149 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11150
11151 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11152 @quotation Note
11153 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11154 @end quotation
11155
11156 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11157 @itemize @bullet
11158 @item j - smp status request
11159 @item J - smp set request
11160 @end itemize
11161
11162 OpenOCD implements :
11163 @itemize @bullet
11164 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11165 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11166 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11167 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11168 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11169 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11170 @end itemize
11171
11172 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11173 @itemize @bullet
11174 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11175 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11176 @example
11177 set $_core 1
11178 #Jc01 packet is sent
11179 print $_core
11180 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11181 @end example
11182
11183 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11184 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11185
11186 @example
11187 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11188 define toggle0
11189 maint packet Jc0
11190 continue
11191 main packet Jc-1
11192 end
11193 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11194 define toggle1
11195 maint packet Jc1
11196 continue
11197 main packet Jc-1
11198 end
11199 @end example
11200 @end itemize
11201
11202 @node Tcl Scripting API
11203 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11204 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11205 @cindex Tcl scripts
11206 @section API rules
11207
11208 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11209 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11210 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11211
11212 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11213 pair list and lists.
11214
11215 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11216 list.
11217
11218 @example
11219 > set foo(me) Duane
11220 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11221 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11222 > set foo(duck) Donald
11223 @end example
11224
11225 If one does this:
11226
11227 @example
11228 > set foo
11229 @end example
11230
11231 The result is:
11232
11233 @example
11234 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11235 @end example
11236
11237 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11238
11239 @verbatim
11240 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11241 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11242 }
11243 @end verbatim
11244
11245 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11246 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11247
11248 @section Internal low-level Commands
11249
11250 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11251 invoke directly.
11252
11253 @itemize @bullet
11254 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11255
11256 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11257 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11258
11259 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11260 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11261
11262 Return information about the flash banks
11263
11264 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11265
11266 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11267 its execution. Example:
11268
11269 @example
11270 > capture "reset init"
11271 @end example
11272
11273 @end itemize
11274
11275 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11276 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11277 called "flash_banks".
11278
11279 @section Tcl RPC server
11280 @cindex RPC
11281
11282 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11283 commands and receive the results.
11284
11285 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11286 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11287 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11288 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11289 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11290
11291 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11292 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11293 @command{capture} command.
11294
11295 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11296
11297 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11298 @cindex RPC Notifications
11299
11300 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11301 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11302
11303 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11304 in the following format.
11305
11306 @verbatim
11307 type target_event event [event-name]
11308 type target_state state [state-name]
11309 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11310 @end verbatim
11311
11312 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11313 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11314 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11315 Defaults to off.
11316
11317 @end deffn
11318
11319 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11320 @cindex RPC trace output
11321
11322 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11323 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11324
11325 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11326
11327 @verbatim
11328 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11329 @end verbatim
11330
11331 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11332 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11333 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11334 Defaults to off.
11335
11336 See an example application here:
11337 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11338
11339 @end deffn
11340
11341 @node FAQ
11342 @chapter FAQ
11343 @cindex faq
11344 @enumerate
11345 @anchor{faqrtck}
11346 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11347 @cindex RTCK
11348 @cindex adaptive clocking
11349 @*
11350
11351 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11352 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11353 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11354 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11355
11356 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11357 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11358 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11359 @enumerate
11360 @item
11361 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11362 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11363 @item
11364 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11365 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11366 @end enumerate
11367
11368 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11369 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11370 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11371 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11372 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11373 power).
11374
11375 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11376 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11377 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11378 ARM926 scenario).
11379 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11380 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11381 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11382
11383 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11384 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11385 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11386 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11387
11388 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11389
11390 In order to make use of this,
11391 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11392 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11393
11394 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11395 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11396 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11397 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11398 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11399
11400 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11401 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11402 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11403 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11404
11405 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11406 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11407 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11408 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11409 with a CPLD.
11410 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11411 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11412 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11413 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11414 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11415 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11416
11417 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11418
11419 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11420
11421 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11422 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11423 depending on the chips on your board.
11424 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11425 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11426 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11427
11428 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11429 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11430 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11431
11432 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11433 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11434 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11435 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11436
11437 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11438 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11439 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11440 this way.
11441
11442 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11443 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11444 clock rate.
11445 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11446 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11447 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11448
11449 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11450
11451 @example
11452 # Example: 1.234MHz
11453 adapter speed 1234
11454 @end example
11455
11456
11457 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11458
11459 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11460 around Windows filenames.
11461
11462 @example
11463 > echo \a
11464
11465 > echo @{\a@}
11466 \a
11467 > echo "\a"
11468
11469 >
11470 @end example
11471
11472
11473 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11474
11475 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11476 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11477 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11478
11479 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11480 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11481 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11482
11483 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11484 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11485 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11486
11487 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11488
11489 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11490 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11491 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11492 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11493
11494 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11495 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11496 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11497
11498 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11499 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11500
11501 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11502 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11503 memory read caused data abort".
11504
11505 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11506 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11507 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11508 be done, feel free to add this here.
11509
11510 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11511 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11512 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11513 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11514 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11515 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11516 gracefully stops.
11517
11518 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11519 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11520 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11521
11522 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11523 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11524 bytes. Painful...
11525
11526
11527 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11528 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11529
11530 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11531 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11532 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11533 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11534 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11535 reset, everything else should work fine.
11536
11537 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11538 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11539 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11540 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11541
11542 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11543 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11544 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11545 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11546
11547 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11548
11549 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11550 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11551 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11552
11553 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11554 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11555
11556 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11557 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11558 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11559 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11560 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11561 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11562 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11563 clock frequency?
11564
11565 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11566 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11567 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11568 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11569 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11570
11571 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11572
11573 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11574 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11575 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11576 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11577 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11578 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11579 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11580
11581 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11582
11583 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11584 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11585 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11586 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11587
11588 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11589 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11590 particular order?
11591
11592 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11593 the same order used by the hardware.
11594
11595 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11596 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11597 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11598 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11599 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11600 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11601
11602 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11603 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11604 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11605 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11606
11607 @itemize @bullet
11608 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11609 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11610 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11611 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11612 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11613 @end itemize
11614
11615 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11616
11617 @itemize @bullet
11618 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11619 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11620 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11621 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11622 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11623 @end itemize
11624
11625
11626 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11627 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11628 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11629
11630 TODO.
11631
11632 @end enumerate
11633
11634 @node Tcl Crash Course
11635 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11636 @cindex Tcl
11637
11638 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11639 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11640 how the Tcl scripts work.
11641
11642 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11643 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11644 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11645 OpenOCD.
11646
11647 @section Tcl Rule #1
11648 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11649 @enumerate
11650 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11651 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11652 @end enumerate
11653
11654 The Tcl equal is this:
11655
11656 @enumerate
11657 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11658 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11659 @end enumerate
11660
11661 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11662 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11663
11664 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11665 There is a second pair of rules.
11666 @enumerate
11667 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11668 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11669 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11670 in Tcl.
11671 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11672 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11673 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11674 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11675 @end enumerate
11676
11677 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11678 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11679 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11680 Everything is a string}
11681
11682 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11683 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11684 difference is subtle.
11685 @enumerate
11686 @item Parse Time
11687 @item Evaluation Time
11688 @end enumerate
11689
11690 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11691 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11692 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11693
11694 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11695 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11696 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11697 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11698
11699 @itemize @bullet
11700 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11701 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11702 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11703 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11704 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11705 @example
11706 # bash example
11707 X=`date`
11708 echo "The Date is: $X"
11709 # Tcl example
11710 set X [date]
11711 puts "The Date is: $X"
11712 @end example
11713 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11714 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11715 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11716 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11717 is a string}
11718 @example
11719 set x "Dinner"
11720 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11721 @end example
11722 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11723 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11724 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11725 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11726 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11727 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11728 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11729 @end itemize
11730
11731 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11732
11733 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11734
11735 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11736
11737 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11738 the normal way.
11739
11740 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11741 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11742 line is immediately executed.
11743
11744 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11745 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11746
11747 @subsection Command Execution
11748
11749 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11750 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11751 control flow operators.
11752
11753 Commands are executed like this:
11754
11755 @enumerate
11756 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11757 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11758 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11759 @end enumerate
11760
11761 It sort of works like this:
11762 @example
11763 for(;;)@{
11764 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11765
11766 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11767
11768 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11769 @}
11770 @end example
11771
11772 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11773 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11774 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11775 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11776 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11777 ``LookupCommand()''
11778
11779 @subsection The FOR command
11780
11781 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11782 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11783 command just like any other command.
11784
11785 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11786 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11787 are:
11788
11789 @enumerate 0
11790 @item The ascii text 'for'
11791 @item The start text
11792 @item The test expression
11793 @item The next text
11794 @item The body text
11795 @end enumerate
11796
11797 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11798 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11799 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11800 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11801
11802 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11803 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11804
11805 @example
11806 int
11807 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11808 int *argc,
11809 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11810 @end example
11811
11812 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11813 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11814 still operates in the same basic way.
11815
11816 @subsection FOR command implementation
11817
11818 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11819 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11820
11821 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11822
11823 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11824
11825 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11826 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11827 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11828
11829 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11830 expression and returns a value.
11831
11832 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11833 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11834 @example
11835 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11836
11837 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11838
11839 int
11840 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11841 int argc,
11842 char **argv )
11843 @{
11844 if( argc != 5 )@{
11845 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11846 return ERROR;
11847 @}
11848
11849 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11850
11851 // Execute the start statement.
11852 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11853
11854 // Top of loop test
11855 for(;;)@{
11856 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11857 if( i == 0 )
11858 break;
11859
11860 // Execute the body
11861 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11862
11863 // Execute the LOOP part
11864 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11865 @}
11866
11867 // Return no error
11868 SetResult( interp, "" );
11869 return SUCCESS;
11870 @}
11871 @end example
11872
11873 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11874 in the same basic way.
11875
11876 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11877
11878 @subsection source and find commands
11879 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11880 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11881 @*Remember the parsing rules
11882 @enumerate
11883 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11884 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11885 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11886 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11887 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11888 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11889 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11890 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11891 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11892 @end enumerate
11893 @subsection format command
11894 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11895 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11896 @b{sprintf()}.
11897 @b{Example}
11898 @example
11899 set x 6
11900 set y 7
11901 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11902 @end example
11903 @enumerate
11904 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11905 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11906 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11907 @* Refer to Rule #1
11908 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11909 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11910 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11911 @end enumerate
11912 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11913 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11914 @example
11915 #1 Good
11916 proc someproc @{@} @{
11917 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11918 @}
11919 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11920 #2 Good - no variables
11921 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11922 #3 Good Curly Braces
11923 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11924 puts "Time: [date]"
11925 @}
11926 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11927 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11928 @end example
11929 @enumerate
11930 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11931 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11932 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11933 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11934 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11935 command.
11936 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11937 @*There are 4 examples:
11938 @enumerate
11939 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11940 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11941 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11942 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11943 @end enumerate
11944
11945 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11946 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11947 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11948
11949 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11950 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11951 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11952 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11953 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11954 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11955 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11956 @end enumerate
11957 @subsection Global Variables
11958 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11959 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11960 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11961 @example
11962 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11963 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11964 global x #Global variable X
11965 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11966 @}
11967 @end example
11968 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11969 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11970 @example
11971 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11972 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11973 # Create var name
11974 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11975 # Make it a global
11976 global $vn
11977 # Set it.
11978 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11979 @}
11980 @end example
11981 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11982 @example
11983 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11984 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11985 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11986 @}
11987 @end example
11988
11989 @node License
11990 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
11991 @include fdl.texi
11992
11993 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11994 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11995 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11996 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11997 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11998 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11999
12000 @printindex cp
12001
12002 @node Command and Driver Index
12003 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12004 @printindex fn
12005
12006 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)